blob: 70a5188862348463f4c5ac69fd58a3179e1351ef [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaua3ecbd92012-12-28 15:04:05 +01007 2012/12/28
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100627. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200637.1. Matching integers
647.2. Matching strings
657.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200667.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200677.5. Available matching criteria
687.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
697.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
707.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
717.6. Pre-defined ACLs
727.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100737.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074
758. Logging
768.1. Log levels
778.2. Log formats
788.2.1. Default log format
798.2.2. TCP log format
808.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100818.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100828.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200838.3. Advanced logging options
848.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
858.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
868.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
878.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
888.4. Timing events
898.5. Session state at disconnection
908.6. Non-printable characters
918.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
928.8. Capturing HTTP headers
938.9. Examples of logs
94
959. Statistics and monitoring
969.1. CSV format
979.2. Unix Socket commands
98
99
1001. Quick reminder about HTTP
101----------------------------
102
103When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
104fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
105on almost anything found in the contents.
106
107However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
108formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
109correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
110
111
1121.1. The HTTP transaction model
113-------------------------------
114
115The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100116to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
118connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
119will involve a new connection :
120
121 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
122
123In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
124establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
125by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
126length.
127
128Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
129to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
130however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
131response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
132header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
133
134 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
135
136Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
137power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
138but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200139a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140
141A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
142keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
143second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
144page :
145
146 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
147
148This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
149latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
150correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
151the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100152server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200154By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
155connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
156everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
157established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
158sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
159while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
160another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
161sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
162http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
163mode.
164
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165
1661.2. HTTP request
167-----------------
168
169First, let's consider this HTTP request :
170
171 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100172 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
174 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
175 3 User-agent: my small browser
176 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
177 5 Accept: image/png
178
179
1801.2.1. The Request line
181-----------------------
182
183Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
184
185 - a METHOD : GET
186 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
187 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
188
189All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
190which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
191followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
192is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
193desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
194the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
195
196The URI itself can have several forms :
197
198 - A "relative URI" :
199
200 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
201
202 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
203 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
204
205 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
206
207 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
210 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
211 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
212 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
213 must accept this form too.
214
215 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
216 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
217 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100218
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
220 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
221 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
222 other protocols too.
223
224In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
225mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
226on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
227It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
228specific to the language, framework or application in use.
229
230
2311.2.2. The request headers
232--------------------------
233
234The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
235beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
236an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
237Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
238values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
239encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
240the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
241define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
242
243Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
244their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
245"Connection:" header).
246
247The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
248that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
249is one valid form of empty line.
250
251Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
252headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
253about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
254application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
255
256Important note:
257 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
258 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
259 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
260 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
261
262
2631.3. HTTP response
264------------------
265
266An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
267messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
268
269 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100270 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200271 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
272 2 Content-length: 350
273 3 Content-Type: text/html
274
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200275As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
276codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
277response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100278continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
279the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
280following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
281sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
282(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
283correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
284such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
285state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
286over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
287if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
288information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200289
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200290
2911.3.1. The Response line
292------------------------
293
294Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
295
296 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
297 - a status code : 200
298 - a reason : OK
299
300The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200301 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200302 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
303 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
304 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
305 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
306
307Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100308"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
310messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
311or "Authentication Required".
312
313Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
314
315 Code When / reason
316 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
317 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
318 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
319 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
320 400 for an invalid or too large request
321 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
322 accessing the stats page)
323 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
324 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
325 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
326 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
327 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
328 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
329 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
330 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
331 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
332
333The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3344.2).
335
336
3371.3.2. The response headers
338---------------------------
339
340Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
341the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
342details.
343
344
3452. Configuring HAProxy
346----------------------
347
3482.1. Configuration file format
349------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200350
351HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
352
353 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
354 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
355 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
356 "frontend" and "backend".
357
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100358The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
359referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
360delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100361preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100362escaped by doubling them.
363
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364
3652.2. Time format
366----------------
367
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100368Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100369values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
370otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
371numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
372for every keyword. Supported units are :
373
374 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
375 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
376 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
377 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
378 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
379 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
380
381
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003822.3. Examples
383-------------
384
385 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
386 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
387 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
388 global
389 daemon
390 maxconn 256
391
392 defaults
393 mode http
394 timeout connect 5000ms
395 timeout client 50000ms
396 timeout server 50000ms
397
398 frontend http-in
399 bind *:80
400 default_backend servers
401
402 backend servers
403 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
404
405
406 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
407 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
408 global
409 daemon
410 maxconn 256
411
412 defaults
413 mode http
414 timeout connect 5000ms
415 timeout client 50000ms
416 timeout server 50000ms
417
418 listen http-in
419 bind *:80
420 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
421
422
423Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
424
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100425 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200426
427
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004283. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200429--------------------
430
431Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
432are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
433of them have command-line equivalents.
434
435The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
436
437 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200438 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200439 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200440 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200441 - daemon
442 - gid
443 - group
444 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100445 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200446 - nbproc
447 - pidfile
448 - uid
449 - ulimit-n
450 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200451 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200452 - node
453 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100454 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100455
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200456 * Performance tuning
457 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200458 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100459 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100460 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100461 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200462 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200463 - noepoll
464 - nokqueue
465 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100466 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200467 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200468 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200469 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100470 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100471 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200472 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100473 - tune.maxaccept
474 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200475 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200476 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100477 - tune.rcvbuf.client
478 - tune.rcvbuf.server
479 - tune.sndbuf.client
480 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100481 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100482 - tune.zlib.memlevel
483 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100484
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200485 * Debugging
486 - debug
487 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200488
489
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004903.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200491------------------------------------
492
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200493ca-base <dir>
494 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200495 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
496 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200497
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200498chroot <jail dir>
499 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
500 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
501 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
502 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
503 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
504 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100505
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100506cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
507 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
508 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
509 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
510 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32,
511 and any process IDs above nbproc are ignored. It is possible to specify all
512 processes at once using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers
513 using "even", just like with the "bind-process" directive. The second and
514 forthcoming arguments are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number
515 between 0 and 31 or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-').
516 Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes will be
517 allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may
518 be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when
519 they overlap.
520
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200521crt-base <dir>
522 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
523 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
524 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
525
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200526daemon
527 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
528 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
529 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
530
531gid <number>
532 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
533 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
534 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100535 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
536 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200537 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100538
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200539group <group name>
540 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
541 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100542
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200543log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200544 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
545 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100546 configured with "log global".
547
548 <address> can be one of:
549
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100550 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100551 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
552 port).
553
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100554 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
555 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
556 port).
557
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100558 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
559 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
560 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
561 writeable).
562
563 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200564
565 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
566 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
567 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
568
569 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200570 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
571 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
572 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
573 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
574 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
575 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200576
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200577 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200578
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100579log-send-hostname [<string>]
580 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
581 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
582 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
583 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
584 the logs.
585
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000586log-tag <string>
587 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
588 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
589 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
590 running on the same host.
591
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200592nbproc <number>
593 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
594 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
595 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
596 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
597 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
598
599pidfile <pidfile>
600 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
601 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
602 starting the process. See also "daemon".
603
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +0100604stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200605 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
606 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
607 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
608 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
609 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
610 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
611 the number of processes used.
612
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200613stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
614 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
615 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
616 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
617 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200618
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200619 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
620 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
621 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200622
623stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
624 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
625 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100626 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200627
628stats maxconn <connections>
629 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
630 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
631
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200632uid <number>
633 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
634 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
635 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
636 one. See also "gid" and "user".
637
638ulimit-n <number>
639 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
640 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
641 option.
642
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100643unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
644 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
645
646 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
647 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
648 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
649 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
650 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
651 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
652 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
653 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
654 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
655 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
656
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200657user <user name>
658 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
659 See also "uid" and "group".
660
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200661node <name>
662 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
663
664 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
665 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
666 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
667 traffic.
668
669description <text>
670 Add a text that describes the instance.
671
672 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
673 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
674 "<" and ">" characters.
675
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200676
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006773.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200678-----------------------
679
680maxconn <number>
681 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
682 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
683 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
684 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
685
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200686maxconnrate <number>
687 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
688 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
689 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
690 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
691 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
692 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
693 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
694 fairness.
695
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100696maxcomprate <number>
697 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
698 pers second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
699 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
700 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
701 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
702 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
703 default value.
704
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100705maxcompcpuusage <number>
706 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
707 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
708 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
709 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
710 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
711 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
712 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
713 process down and from introducing high latencies.
714
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100715maxpipes <number>
716 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
717 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
718 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
719 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
720 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
721 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
722
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200723maxsslconn <number>
724 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
725 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
726 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
727 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
728 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
729 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
730 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
731
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100732maxzlibmem <number>
733 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
734 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
735 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100736 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
737 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
738 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
739
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200740noepoll
741 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
742 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100743 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200744
745nokqueue
746 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
747 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
748 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
749
750nopoll
751 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
752 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100753 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100754 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200755
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100756nosplice
757 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
758 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
759 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100760 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100761 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
762 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
763 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
764 "option splice-response".
765
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200766spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
767 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
768 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
769 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
770 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
771 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
772
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200773tune.bufsize <number>
774 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
775 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
776 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
777 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
778 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
779 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
780 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
781 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400782 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
783 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
784 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200785
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200786tune.chksize <number>
787 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
788 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
789 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
790 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
791 checks whenever possible.
792
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100793tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
794 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
795 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
796 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
797 this value. The default value is 1.
798
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100799tune.http.cookielen <number>
800 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
801 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
802 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
803 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
804 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
805 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
806 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
807 to change this value.
808
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200809tune.http.maxhdr <number>
810 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
811 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
812 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
813 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
814 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
815 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
816 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
817 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
818 limit too high.
819
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100820tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100821 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
822 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
823 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
824 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
825 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
826 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
827 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
828 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
829 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
830 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100831
832tune.maxpollevents <number>
833 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
834 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
835 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
836 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
837 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
838
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200839tune.maxrewrite <number>
840 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
841 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
842 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
843 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
844 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
845 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
846 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
847 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
848 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
849 bufsize.
850
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200851tune.pipesize <number>
852 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
853 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
854 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
855 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
856 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
857 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
858
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100859tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
860tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
861 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
862 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
863 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
864 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
865 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
866 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
867 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
868
869tune.sndbuf.client <number>
870tune.sndbuf.server <number>
871 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
872 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
873 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
874 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
875 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
876 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
877 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
878 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
879 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
880 notifying haproxy again.
881
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100882tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100883 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
884 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
885 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
886 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block use approximatively
887 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
888 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
889 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
890 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
891 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +0100892 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
893 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100894
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100895tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
896 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
897 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 mn). It is important to understand that it
898 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
899 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
900 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
901 being used for too long.
902
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100903tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
904 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
905 defines how much memory should be allocated for the intenal compression
906 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
907 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
908 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
909
910tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
911 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
912 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
913 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
914 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200915
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009163.3. Debugging
917--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200918
919debug
920 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
921 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
922 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
923 system startup.
924
925quiet
926 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
927 line argument "-q".
928
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200929
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009303.4. Userlists
931--------------
932It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
933http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
934it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
935
936userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100937 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100938 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
939
940group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100941 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100942 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
943 proceeded by "users" keyword.
944
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100945user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
946 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100947 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
948 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100949 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
950 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100951 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
952 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
953
954
955 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100956 userlist L1
957 group G1 users tiger,scott
958 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100959
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100960 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
961 user scott insecure-password elgato
962 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100963
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100964 userlist L2
965 group G1
966 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100967
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100968 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
969 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
970 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100971
972 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200973
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200974
9753.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200976----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200977It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
978haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
979pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
980identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
981or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
982Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
983known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
984the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
985process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
986during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
987tables.
988
989peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400990 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200991 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
992
993peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
994 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
995 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
996 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
997 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
998 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
999 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1000
1001 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1002 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1003
1004 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1005 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1006 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1007 across all peers.
1008
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001009 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001010 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001011 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1012 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1013 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001014
1015 backend mybackend
1016 mode tcp
1017 balance roundrobin
1018 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1019 stick on src
1020
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001021 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1022 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001023
1024
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010254. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001026----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001027
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001028Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1029 - defaults <name>
1030 - frontend <name>
1031 - backend <name>
1032 - listen <name>
1033
1034A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1035its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1036section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001037section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001038
1039A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1040connections.
1041
1042A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1043to forward incoming connections.
1044
1045A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1046parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1047
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001048All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1049'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1050case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1051
1052Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1053logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1054proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1055However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1056name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1057
1058Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1059and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001060bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001061protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1062modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1063arbitrary criteria.
1064
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001065
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010664.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1067--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001068
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001069The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1070limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1071they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1072limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001073marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001074option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001075and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1076with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1077specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001078
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001079
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001080 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1081------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1082acl - X X X
1083appsession - - X X
1084backlog X X X -
1085balance X - X X
1086bind - X X -
1087bind-process X X X X
1088block - X X X
1089capture cookie - X X -
1090capture request header - X X -
1091capture response header - X X -
1092clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001093compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001094contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1095cookie X - X X
1096default-server X - X X
1097default_backend X X X -
1098description - X X X
1099disabled X X X X
1100dispatch - - X X
1101enabled X X X X
1102errorfile X X X X
1103errorloc X X X X
1104errorloc302 X X X X
1105-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1106errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001107force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001108fullconn X - X X
1109grace X X X X
1110hash-type X - X X
1111http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001112http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001113http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001114http-request - X X X
1115id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001116ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001117log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001118maxconn X X X -
1119mode X X X X
1120monitor fail - X X -
1121monitor-net X X X -
1122monitor-uri X X X -
1123option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1124option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1125option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1126option allbackups (*) X - X X
1127option checkcache (*) X - X X
1128option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1129option contstats (*) X X X -
1130option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1131option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1132option forceclose (*) X X X X
1133-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1134option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001135option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001136option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001137option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1138option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1139option httpchk X - X X
1140option httpclose (*) X X X X
1141option httplog X X X X
1142option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001143option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Simon Hormana2b9dad2013-02-12 10:45:54 +09001144option lb-agent-chk X - X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001145option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001146option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1147option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1148option logasap (*) X X X -
1149option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001150option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001151option nolinger (*) X X X X
1152option originalto X X X X
1153option persist (*) X - X X
1154option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001155option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001156option smtpchk X - X X
1157option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1158option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1159option splice-request (*) X X X X
1160option splice-response (*) X X X X
1161option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1162option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1163-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1164option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1165option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1166option tcpka X X X X
1167option tcplog X X X X
1168option transparent (*) X - X X
1169persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1170rate-limit sessions X X X -
1171redirect - X X X
1172redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1173redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1174reqadd - X X X
1175reqallow - X X X
1176reqdel - X X X
1177reqdeny - X X X
1178reqiallow - X X X
1179reqidel - X X X
1180reqideny - X X X
1181reqipass - X X X
1182reqirep - X X X
1183reqisetbe - X X X
1184reqitarpit - X X X
1185reqpass - X X X
1186reqrep - X X X
1187-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1188reqsetbe - X X X
1189reqtarpit - X X X
1190retries X - X X
1191rspadd - X X X
1192rspdel - X X X
1193rspdeny - X X X
1194rspidel - X X X
1195rspideny - X X X
1196rspirep - X X X
1197rsprep - X X X
1198server - - X X
1199source X - X X
1200srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001201stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001202stats auth X - X X
1203stats enable X - X X
1204stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001205stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001206stats realm X - X X
1207stats refresh X - X X
1208stats scope X - X X
1209stats show-desc X - X X
1210stats show-legends X - X X
1211stats show-node X - X X
1212stats uri X - X X
1213-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1214stick match - - X X
1215stick on - - X X
1216stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001217stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001218stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001219tcp-request connection - X X -
1220tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001221tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001222tcp-response content - - X X
1223tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001224timeout check X - X X
1225timeout client X X X -
1226timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1227timeout connect X - X X
1228timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1229timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1230timeout http-request X X X X
1231timeout queue X - X X
1232timeout server X - X X
1233timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1234timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001235timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001236transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001237unique-id-format X X X -
1238unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001239use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001240use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001241------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1242 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001243
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001244
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012454.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1246---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001247
1248This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1249
1250
1251acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1252 Declare or complete an access list.
1253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1254 no | yes | yes | yes
1255 Example:
1256 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1257 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1258 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1259
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001260 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001261
1262
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001263appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1264 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001265 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1267 no | no | yes | yes
1268 Arguments :
1269 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1270 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1271
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001272 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001273 checked in each cookie value.
1274
1275 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1276 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1277 milliseconds.
1278
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001279 request-learn
1280 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1281 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1282 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1283 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1284 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1285 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1286
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001287 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1288 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1289 data following this prefix.
1290
1291 Example :
1292 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1293
1294 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1295 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1296
1297 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1298 2 modes are currently supported :
1299 - path-parameters :
1300 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1301 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1302 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1303 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1304 - query-string :
1305 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1306 query string.
1307
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001308 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1309 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1310 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1311 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001312 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1313 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1314 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001315 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1316 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1317
1318 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1319
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001320 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1321 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1322 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1323
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001324 Example :
1325 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1326
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001327 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1328 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001329
1330
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001331backlog <conns>
1332 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1334 yes | yes | yes | no
1335 Arguments :
1336 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1337 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001338 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001339
1340 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1341 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1342 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1343 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1344 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1345 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1346 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1347 backlog parameter.
1348
1349 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1350 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1351 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1352
1353 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1354
1355
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001356balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001357balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001358 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1360 yes | no | yes | yes
1361 Arguments :
1362 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1363 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1364 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1365 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1366
1367 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1368 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1369 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1370 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001371 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1372 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1373 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1374 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1375 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1376 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1377 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1378 it, so that you don't worry.
1379
1380 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1381 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1382 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1383 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1384 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1385 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1386 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1387 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001388
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001389 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1390 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1391 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1392 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1393 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1394 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1395 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1396 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1397
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001398 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1399 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1400 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1401 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001402 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001403 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1404 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1405 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1406 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1407 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001408 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1409 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1410 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1411 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1412 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1413 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001414
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001415 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1416 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1417 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1418 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1419 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1420 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1421 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1422 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001423 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001424 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001425 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1426 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1427 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001428
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001429 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1430 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1431 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1432 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1433 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1434 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1435 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1436 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1437 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1438 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1439 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1440 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001441
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001442 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001443 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1444 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1445 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1446 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1447 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1448 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1449 URIs start with a leading "/".
1450
1451 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1452 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1453 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1454 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1455
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001456 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001457 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1458
1459 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001460 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1461 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1462 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1463 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1464 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1465 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1466 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1467 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1468 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1469 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1470 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1471 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1472 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1473 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1474 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1475 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1476 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1477 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1478 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001479
1480 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1481 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1482 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1483 server will receive the request.
1484
1485 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1486 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1487 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1488 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1489 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001490 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1491 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1492 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001493
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001494 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1495 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1496 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1497 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1498 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001499
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001500 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001501 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1502 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1503 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1504
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001505 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1506 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1507 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1508
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001509 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001510 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001511 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1512 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1513 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1514 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1515 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1516 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001517 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001518 used instead.
1519
1520 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1521 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1522 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1523 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1524
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001525 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1526 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1527 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1528
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001529 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001530
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001531 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001532 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1533 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001534
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001535 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001536 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001537
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001538 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1539 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1540 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001541
1542 Examples :
1543 balance roundrobin
1544 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001545 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001546 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1547 balance hdr(host)
1548 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001549
1550 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1551 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1552
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001553 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001554 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1555 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1556 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1557 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1558
1559 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1560 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1561 defaults to 16 kB.
1562
1563 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1564 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1565
1566 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1567 Round Robin.
1568
1569 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1570 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1571 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1572 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1573
1574 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1575
1576 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001577 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001578 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1579 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1580 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001581
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001582 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1583 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001584
1585
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001586bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1587bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001588 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1589 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1590 no | yes | yes | no
1591 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001592 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1593 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1594 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1595 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001596 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001597
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001598 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1599 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001600 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1601 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1602 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001603 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1604 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1605 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1606 the range.
1607
1608 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1609 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1610 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1611 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1612 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1613 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1614 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001615 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001616 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001617
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001618 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1619 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1620 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1621 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1622 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1623 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1624 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1625 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1626
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001627 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1628 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1629 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1630 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001631
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001632 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1633 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1634 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1635 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1636 in a frontend.
1637
1638 Example :
1639 listen http_proxy
1640 bind :80,:443
1641 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001642 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001643
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001644 listen http_https_proxy
1645 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001646 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001647
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001648 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001649 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001650
1651
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001652bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001653 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1654 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1655 yes | yes | yes | yes
1656 Arguments :
1657 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1658 may be used to override a default value.
1659
1660 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1661 option may be combined with other numbers.
1662
1663 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1664 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1665 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1666 missing from all processes.
1667
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001668 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
1669 whose values must all be between 1 and 32. You must be
1670 careful not to reference a process number greater than the
1671 configured global.nbproc, otherwise some instances might be
1672 missing from all processes.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001673
1674 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1675 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1676 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1677 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1678 and 'even' instances.
1679
1680 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1681 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1682 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1683 32.
1684
1685 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1686 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1687
1688 Example :
1689 listen app_ip1
1690 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001691 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001692
1693 listen app_ip2
1694 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001695 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001696
1697 listen management
1698 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001699 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001700
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001701 listen management
1702 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1703 bind-process 1-4
1704
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001705 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1706
1707
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001708block { if | unless } <condition>
1709 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1710 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1711 no | yes | yes | yes
1712
1713 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1714 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001715 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001716 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001717 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1718 "block" statements per instance.
1719
1720 Example:
1721 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1722 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1723 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1724 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1725
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001726 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001727
1728
1729capture cookie <name> len <length>
1730 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1732 no | yes | yes | no
1733 Arguments :
1734 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1735 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1736 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1737 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1738 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1739
1740 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1741 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1742 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1743 right if it exceeds <length>.
1744
1745 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1746 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1747 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1748 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1749
1750 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1751 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1752 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1753
1754 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1755 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1756 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001757 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1758 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1759 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001760
1761 Example:
1762 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1763
1764 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001765 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001766
1767
1768capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001769 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001770 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1771 no | yes | yes | no
1772 Arguments :
1773 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001774 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001775 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1776 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1777 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1778
1779 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1780 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1781 it exceeds <length>.
1782
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001783 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001784 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1785 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001786 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1787 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1788 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1789 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001790 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001791 environments to find where the request came from.
1792
1793 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1794 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1795 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1796 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001797
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001798 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
1799 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1800 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1801 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1802 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001803
1804 Example:
1805 capture request header Host len 15
1806 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1807 capture request header Referrer len 15
1808
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001809 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001810 about logging.
1811
1812
1813capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001814 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1816 no | yes | yes | no
1817 Arguments :
1818 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001819 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001820 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1821 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1822 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1823
1824 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1825 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1826 it exceeds <length>.
1827
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001828 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001829 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1830 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1831 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001832 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1833 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1834 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1835 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001836
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001837 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
1838 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1839 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1840 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1841 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001842
1843 Example:
1844 capture response header Content-length len 9
1845 capture response header Location len 15
1846
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001847 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001848 about logging.
1849
1850
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001851clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001852 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1853 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1854 yes | yes | yes | no
1855 Arguments :
1856 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1857 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1858 as explained at the top of this document.
1859
1860 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1861 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1862 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1863 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1864 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1865 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1866 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1867 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001868 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001869 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1870 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1871
1872 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1873 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1874 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1875 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1876 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1877 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1878
1879 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1880 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1881
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001882 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1883 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001884
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001885compression algo <algorithm> ...
1886compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001887compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001888 Enable HTTP compression.
1889 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1890 yes | yes | yes | yes
1891 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001892 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
1893 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
1894 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
1895
1896 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04001897 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001898 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
1899 data.
1900
1901 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
1902 support for zlib was built in.
1903
1904 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
1905 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
1906 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
1907 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
1908 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
1909 in.
1910
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04001911 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001912 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04001913 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
1914 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
1915 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
1916 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
1917 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001918
1919 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
1920 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
1921 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
1922 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
1923 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04001924 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
1925 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
1926 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
1927 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
1928 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
1929 then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001930
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01001931 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01001932 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
1933 "Accept-Encoding" header
1934 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01001935 * HTTP status code is not 200
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01001936 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
1937 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
1938 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
1939 "multipart"
1940 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
1941 header
1942 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
1943 and later
1944 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
1945 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01001946
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01001947 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
1948 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01001949
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001950 Examples :
1951 compression algo gzip
1952 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001953
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001954contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001955 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1956 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1957 yes | no | yes | yes
1958 Arguments :
1959 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1960 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1961 as explained at the top of this document.
1962
1963 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001964 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001965 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001966 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1967 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1968 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1969 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1970
1971 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1972 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1973 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1974 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1975 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1976 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1977
1978 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1979 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1980 instead.
1981
1982 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1983 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1984
1985
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001986cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02001987 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
1988 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001989 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1991 yes | no | yes | yes
1992 Arguments :
1993 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1994 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1995 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1996 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1997 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1998 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1999 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2000 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2001 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2002
2003 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2004 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2005 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2006 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2007 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2008 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2009 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2010 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2011 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2012 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2013 "insert" and "prefix".
2014
2015 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002016 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002017
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002018 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002019 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2020 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2021 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2022 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2023 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2024 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2025 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2026 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2027 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2028 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002029
2030 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2031 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2032 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2033 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2034 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2035 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2036 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2037 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2038 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2039 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002040 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2041 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2042 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002043
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002044 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2045 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2046 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002047 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2048 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2049 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2050 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002051 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2052 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2053 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002054
2055 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2056 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2057 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2058 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2059 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2060 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2061 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2062 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2063 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2064
2065 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2066 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2067 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2068 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2069 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2070 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2071 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2072 persistence cookie in the cache.
2073 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2074
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002075 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2076 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2077 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2078 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2079 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2080 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2081 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2082 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2083 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2084 they logout.
2085
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002086 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2087 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2088 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2089 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2090
2091 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2092 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2093 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2094 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2095 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2096 this attribute.
2097
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002098 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002099 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002100 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2101 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2102 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2103 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2104 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2105 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002106
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002107 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2108 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2109 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2110 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2111 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2112 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2113 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2114 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2115 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2116 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2117 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2118 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2119 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2120 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2121 the site.
2122
2123 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2124 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2125 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2126 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2127 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2128 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2129 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2130 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2131 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2132 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2133 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2134 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2135 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2136 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2137 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2138 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2139
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002140 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2141 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2142 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2143 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002144
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002145 Examples :
2146 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2147 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2148 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002149 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002150
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002151 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002152 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002153
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002154
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002155default-server [param*]
2156 Change default options for a server in a backend
2157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2158 yes | no | yes | yes
2159 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002160 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2161 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2162 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2163 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002164
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002165 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002166 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2167
2168 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002169
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002170
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002171default_backend <backend>
2172 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2173 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2174 yes | yes | yes | no
2175 Arguments :
2176 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2177
2178 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2179 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2180 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2181 will catch all undetermined requests.
2182
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002183 Example :
2184
2185 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2186 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2187 default_backend dynamic
2188
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002189 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2190
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002191
2192disabled
2193 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2195 yes | yes | yes | yes
2196 Arguments : none
2197
2198 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2199 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2200 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2201 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2202 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2203 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2204 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2205
2206 See also : "enabled"
2207
2208
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002209dispatch <address>:<port>
2210 Set a default server address
2211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2212 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002213 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002214
2215 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2216 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2217 during start-up.
2218
2219 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2220 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2221 possible with normal servers.
2222
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002223 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002224 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2225 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2226 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2227 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2228
2229 See also : "server"
2230
2231
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002232enabled
2233 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2234 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2235 yes | yes | yes | yes
2236 Arguments : none
2237
2238 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2239 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2240
2241 See also : "disabled"
2242
2243
2244errorfile <code> <file>
2245 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2247 yes | yes | yes | yes
2248 Arguments :
2249 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002250 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002251
2252 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002253 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002254 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002255 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2256 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002257
2258 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2259 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2260 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2261
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002262 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2263
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002264 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2265 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2266 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2267 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2268
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002269 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2270 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2271 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2272 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2273 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2274 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2275
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002276 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2277 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2278 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002279 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002280 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2281
2282 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2283
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002284 Example :
2285 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2286 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2287 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2288
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002289
2290errorloc <code> <url>
2291errorloc302 <code> <url>
2292 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2294 yes | yes | yes | yes
2295 Arguments :
2296 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002297 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002298
2299 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2300 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2301 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2302 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2303 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2304
2305 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2306 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2307 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2308
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002309 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2310
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002311 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2312 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2313 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2314 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2315 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2316 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2317 request.
2318
2319 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2320
2321
2322errorloc303 <code> <url>
2323 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2325 yes | yes | yes | yes
2326 Arguments :
2327 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2328 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2329
2330 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2331 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2332 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2333 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2334 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2335
2336 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2337 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2338 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2339
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002340 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2341
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002342 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2343 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2344 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2345 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002346 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002347
2348 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2349
2350
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002351force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2352 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2353 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2354 no | yes | yes | yes
2355
2356 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2357 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2358 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2359 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2360 marked down for maintenance operations.
2361
2362 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2363 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2364 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2365 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2366 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2367 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2368 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2369 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2370 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2371
2372 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2373 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2374 is used.
2375
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002376 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002377 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002378
2379
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002380fullconn <conns>
2381 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2383 yes | no | yes | yes
2384 Arguments :
2385 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2386 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2387
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002388 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002389 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002390 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002391 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2392 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2393 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2394 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2395 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002396 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002397
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002398 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2399 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2400 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2401
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002402 Example :
2403 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2404 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2405 # connections.
2406 backend dynamic
2407 fullconn 10000
2408 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2409 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2410
2411 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2412
2413
2414grace <time>
2415 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002417 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002418 Arguments :
2419 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2420 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2421 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2422
2423 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2424 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002425 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002426 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2427
2428 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2429 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2430 simplify it.
2431
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002432
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002433hash-type <method>
2434 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2436 yes | no | yes | yes
2437 Arguments :
2438 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2439 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2440 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2441 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2442 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2443 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2444 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2445 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2446 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2447
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002448 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2449 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2450 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2451 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2452 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2453 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2454 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2455 this value.
2456
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002457 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2458 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2459 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2460 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2461 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2462 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2463 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2464 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2465 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2466 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2467 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2468 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2469 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2470
2471 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2472
2473 See also : "balance", "server"
2474
2475
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002476http-check disable-on-404
2477 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002479 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002480 Arguments : none
2481
2482 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2483 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2484 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2485 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2486 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2487 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2488 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2489 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002490 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2491 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2492 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2493
2494 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2495
2496
2497http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002498 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002499 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002500 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002501 Arguments :
2502 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2503 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002504 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002505 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2506 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2507 details on the supported keywords.
2508
2509 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2510 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2511 with the usual backslash ('\').
2512
2513 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2514 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2515 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2516 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2517 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2518
2519 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002520 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002521 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2522 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2523 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2524
2525 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002526 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002527 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2528 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2529 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2530 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2531
2532 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002533 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002534 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2535 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2536 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2537 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2538 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2539 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2540 trace).
2541
2542 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002543 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002544 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2545 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2546 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2547 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2548 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2549 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2550
2551 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2552 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2553 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2554 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2555 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2556 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2557 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2558 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2559
2560 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2561 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2562
2563 Examples :
2564 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002565 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002566
2567 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002568 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002569
2570 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002571 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002572
2573 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002574 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002575
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002576 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002577
2578
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002579http-check send-state
2580 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2582 yes | no | yes | yes
2583 Arguments : none
2584
2585 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2586 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2587 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2588 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2589 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2590
2591 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2592 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2593 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2594 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2595 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2596 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2597 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2598 checked in multiple backends.
2599
2600 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2601 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2602
2603 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2604 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2605 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2606 one fails.
2607
2608 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2609 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2610 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2611
2612 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2613 server's queue.
2614
2615 Example of a header received by the application server :
2616 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2617 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2618
2619 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2620
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002621http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002622 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002623 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002624 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2625
2626 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2627 no | yes | yes | yes
2628
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002629 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2630 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2631 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2632 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2633 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002634
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002635 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2636 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2637 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2638
2639 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2640 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2641 are evaluated.
2642
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002643 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2644 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2645 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2646 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2647 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2648 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2649 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2650 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2651 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
2652 developped robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
2653 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2654
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002655 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2656 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2657 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2658 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2659 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2660
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002661 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2662 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2663 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
2664 "http-request" rules. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
2665
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002666 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2667 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2668 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2669 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2670 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2671 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2672 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2673 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2674
2675 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2676 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2677 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2678 external users.
2679
2680 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
2681
2682 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
2683 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
2684 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
2685 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002686
2687 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002688 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2689 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2690 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002691
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002692 http-request allow if nagios
2693 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2694 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2695 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002696
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002697 Example:
2698 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002699 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002700
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002701 Example:
2702 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
2703 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
2704 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
2705 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
2706 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
2707 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
2708 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
2709 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
2710 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
2711
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002712 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2713 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002714
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05002715http-send-name-header [<header>]
2716 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
2717
2718 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2719 yes | no | yes | yes
2720
2721 Arguments :
2722
2723 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
2724
2725 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
2726 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
2727 is added with the header string proved.
2728
2729 See also : "server"
2730
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002731id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002732 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2733 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2734 no | yes | yes | yes
2735 Arguments : none
2736
2737 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2738 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2739 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002740
2741
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002742ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2743 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2744 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2745 no | yes | yes | yes
2746
2747 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2748 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2749 and running).
2750
2751 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2752 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2753 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2754 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2755 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2756
2757 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2758 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2759
2760 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2761 "unless" condition is met.
2762
2763 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2764
2765
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002766log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002767log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002768no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002769 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2770 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2771 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002772
2773 Prefix :
2774 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
2775 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
2776 prefix does not allow arguments.
2777
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002778 Arguments :
2779 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2780 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2781 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2782 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2783 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2784 parameter.
2785
2786 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2787 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2788
2789 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2790 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2791 standard syslog port).
2792
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002793 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2794 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2795 standard syslog port).
2796
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002797 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2798 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2799 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2800 appropriately writeable).
2801
2802 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2803
2804 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2805 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2806 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2807
2808 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2809 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2810 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002811 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2812 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2813 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2814 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2815 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002816
2817 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2818
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002819 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
2820 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
2821 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002822
2823 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2824 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2825 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2826 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2827
2828 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2829 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002830
2831 Example :
2832 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002833 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2834 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002835
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01002836log-format <string>
2837 Allows you to custom a log line.
2838
2839 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
2840
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002841
2842maxconn <conns>
2843 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2845 yes | yes | yes | no
2846 Arguments :
2847 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2848 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2849 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2850 closes.
2851
2852 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2853 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2854 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2855 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2856 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2857 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2858 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2859 properly tuned.
2860
2861 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2862 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2863 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2864
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02002865 By default, this value is set to 2000.
2866
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002867 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2868
2869
2870mode { tcp|http|health }
2871 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2872 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2873 yes | yes | yes | yes
2874 Arguments :
2875 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2876 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2877 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2878 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2879
2880 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2881 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2882 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2883 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2884 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2885
2886 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002887 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
2888 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
2889 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
2890 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
2891 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
2892 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
2893 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002894
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002895 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2896 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2897 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002898
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002899 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002900 defaults http_instances
2901 mode http
2902
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002903 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002904
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002905
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002906monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002907 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2909 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002910 Arguments :
2911 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2912 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002913 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002914 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2915 backend and its backup.
2916
2917 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2918 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2919 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2920 servers in a list of backends.
2921
2922 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2923 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2924 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2925 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2926 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2927 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2928 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002929 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
2930 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002931
2932 Example:
2933 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002934 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002935 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2936 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2937 monitor-uri /site_alive
2938 monitor fail if site_dead
2939
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002940 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002941
2942
2943monitor-net <source>
2944 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2946 yes | yes | yes | no
2947 Arguments :
2948 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2949 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2950 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2951 followed by a mask.
2952
2953 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2954 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002955 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002956 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2957
2958 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2959 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2960 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2961 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002962 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
2963 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
2964 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002965
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002966 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
2967 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
2968 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
2969 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
2970 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
2971 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002972
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002973 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2974 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002975
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002976 Example :
2977 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2978 frontend www
2979 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2980
2981 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2982
2983
2984monitor-uri <uri>
2985 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2987 yes | yes | yes | no
2988 Arguments :
2989 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2990 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2991
2992 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2993 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2994 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2995 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2996 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2997 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2998 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2999 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3000
3001 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3002 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3003 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3004 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3005 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3006 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3007
3008 Example :
3009 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3010 frontend www
3011 mode http
3012 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3013
3014 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3015
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003016
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003017option abortonclose
3018no option abortonclose
3019 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3021 yes | no | yes | yes
3022 Arguments : none
3023
3024 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3025 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3026 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3027 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003028 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003029 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3030 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3031 encountered while delivering the response.
3032
3033 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3034 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3035 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3036 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3037 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3038 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003039 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003040 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003041 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003042 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3043 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3044 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3045
3046 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3047 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3048 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3049 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3050 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3051 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3052 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3053 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003054 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003055
3056 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3057 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3058
3059 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3060
3061
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003062option accept-invalid-http-request
3063no option accept-invalid-http-request
3064 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3065 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3066 yes | yes | yes | no
3067 Arguments : none
3068
3069 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3070 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3071 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3072 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3073 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3074 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3075 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3076 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003077 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3078 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3079 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3080 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3081 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3082 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003083
3084 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3085 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3086 been confirmed.
3087
3088 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3089 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003090 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3091 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003092 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3093
3094 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3095 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3096
3097 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3098 stats socket.
3099
3100
3101option accept-invalid-http-response
3102no option accept-invalid-http-response
3103 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3105 yes | no | yes | yes
3106 Arguments : none
3107
3108 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3109 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3110 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3111 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3112 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3113 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3114 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3115 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3116 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3117
3118 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3119 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3120 been confirmed.
3121
3122 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3123 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3124 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3125 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3126
3127 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3128 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3129
3130 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3131 stats socket.
3132
3133
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003134option allbackups
3135no option allbackups
3136 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3138 yes | no | yes | yes
3139 Arguments : none
3140
3141 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3142 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3143 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3144 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3145 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3146 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3147 order between the backup servers anymore.
3148
3149 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3150 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3151
3152 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3153 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3154
3155
3156option checkcache
3157no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003158 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3160 yes | no | yes | yes
3161 Arguments : none
3162
3163 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3164 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003165 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003166 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3167 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003168 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003169
3170 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003171 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003172 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003173 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3174 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003175 to the client are :
3176 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003177 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003178 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003179 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3180 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3181 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3182 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3183 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3184 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3185 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3186 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3187 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3188 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3189 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3190
3191 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003192 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003193 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003194 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003195 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3196
3197 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3198 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003199 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003200 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3201
3202 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3203 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3204
3205
3206option clitcpka
3207no option clitcpka
3208 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3210 yes | yes | yes | no
3211 Arguments : none
3212
3213 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3214 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3215 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3216 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3217
3218 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3219 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3220 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3221 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3222
3223 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3224 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3225 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3226 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3227 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3228
3229 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3230
3231 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3232 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3233 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3234
3235 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3236 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3237
3238 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3239
3240
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003241option contstats
3242 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3244 yes | yes | yes | no
3245 Arguments : none
3246
3247 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3248 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3249 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3250 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3251 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3252 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3253 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3254
3255
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003256option dontlog-normal
3257no option dontlog-normal
3258 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3260 yes | yes | yes | no
3261 Arguments : none
3262
3263 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3264 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3265 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3266 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3267 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3268 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3269 logged.
3270
3271 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3272 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3273 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3274
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003275 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003276 logging.
3277
3278
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003279option dontlognull
3280no option dontlognull
3281 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3283 yes | yes | yes | no
3284 Arguments : none
3285
3286 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3287 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3288 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3289 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3290 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3291 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3292 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3293
3294 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3295 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3296 would not be logged.
3297
3298 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3299 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3300
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003301 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003302
3303
3304option forceclose
3305no option forceclose
3306 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003308 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003309 Arguments : none
3310
3311 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3312 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3313 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3314 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3315 global session times in the logs.
3316
3317 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003318 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003319 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3320 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3321 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3322 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003323
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003324 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3325 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3326 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3327
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003328 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3329 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3330
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003331 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003332
3333
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003334option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003335 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3337 yes | yes | yes | yes
3338 Arguments :
3339 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3340 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003341 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003342 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003343
3344 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3345 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3346 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3347 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3348 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3349 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3350 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003351 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3352 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3353 possible that the client has already brought one.
3354
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003355 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003356 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003357 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3358 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003359 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3360 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003361
3362 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3363 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3364 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3365 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3366 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3367 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3368 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3369
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003370 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3371 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3372 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3373 are under the control of the end-user.
3374
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003375 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003376 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3377 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003378 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3379 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3380 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003381
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003382 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3383 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3384 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3385 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3386 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003387
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003388 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003389 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3390 frontend www
3391 mode http
3392 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3393
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003394 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3395 backend www
3396 mode http
3397 option forwardfor header X-Client
3398
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003399 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3400 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003401
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003402
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003403option http-no-delay
3404no option http-no-delay
3405 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3407 yes | yes | yes | yes
3408 Arguments : none
3409
3410 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3411 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3412 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3413 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3414 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3415 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3416 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3417 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3418 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3419 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3420 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3421 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3422 affected.
3423
3424 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3425 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3426 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3427 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3428 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3429 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3430 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3431 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3432 latency environments.
3433
3434
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003435option http-pretend-keepalive
3436no option http-pretend-keepalive
3437 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3439 yes | yes | yes | yes
3440 Arguments : none
3441
3442 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3443 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3444 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3445 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3446 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3447 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3448 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3449 consider the response complete.
3450
3451 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3452 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3453 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3454 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3455 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3456 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3457
3458 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3459 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3460 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3461 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3462 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3463 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3464 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3465
3466 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3467 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003468 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003469 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3470 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003471
3472 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3473 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3474
3475 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3476
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003477
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003478option http-server-close
3479no option http-server-close
3480 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3481 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3482 yes | yes | yes | yes
3483 Arguments : none
3484
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003485 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3486 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3487 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3488 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3489 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3490 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3491 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3492 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3493 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3494 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3495 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3496 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003497
3498 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3499 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3500 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3501 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003502 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3503 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003504
3505 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3506 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003507 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3508 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3509 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003510
3511 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3512 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3513
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003514 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3515 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003516
3517
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003518option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003519no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003520 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3522 yes | yes | yes | no
3523 Arguments : none
3524
3525 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3526 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3527 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3528 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3529 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3530 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3531 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3532
3533 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3534 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3535 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3536 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3537 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3538 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3539 request along its whole life.
3540
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003541 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3542 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3543 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3544 front of an existing proxy.
3545
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003546 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3547
3548 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3549 http-server-close".
3550
3551
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003552option httpchk
3553option httpchk <uri>
3554option httpchk <method> <uri>
3555option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3556 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3557 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3558 yes | no | yes | yes
3559 Arguments :
3560 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3561 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3562 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3563 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3564 ones.
3565
3566 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3567 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3568 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3569
3570 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3571 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3572 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3573 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3574 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3575
3576 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3577 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3578 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3579 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3580 the lack of any response.
3581
3582 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3583
3584 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3585 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3586 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3587
3588 Examples :
3589 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3590 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3591 backend https_relay
3592 mode tcp
3593 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3594 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3595
Simon Hormana2b9dad2013-02-12 10:45:54 +09003596 See also : "option lb-agent-chk", "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk",
3597 "option mysql-check", "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and
3598 the "check", "port" and "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003599
3600
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003601option httpclose
3602no option httpclose
3603 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3605 yes | yes | yes | yes
3606 Arguments : none
3607
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003608 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3609 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3610 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3611 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3612 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3613 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3614 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003615
3616 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003617 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003618 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3619 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3620 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3621 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3622 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003623
3624 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3625 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3626 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003627 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3628 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003629
3630 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3631 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3632
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003633 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3634 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003635
3636
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003637option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003638 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3639 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3640 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003641 Arguments :
3642 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3643 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3644 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3645 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3646 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003647
3648 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3649 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3650 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3651 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3652 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3653 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3654 ports.
3655
3656 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3657
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003658 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3659 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3660 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3661 by default.
3662
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003663 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003664
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003665
3666option http_proxy
3667no option http_proxy
3668 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3670 yes | yes | yes | yes
3671 Arguments : none
3672
3673 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3674 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3675 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3676 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3677 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3678
3679 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3680 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3681 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3682 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003683 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003684 be analyzed.
3685
3686 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3687 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3688
3689 Example :
3690 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3691 backend direct_forward
3692 option httpclose
3693 option http_proxy
3694
3695 See also : "option httpclose"
3696
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003697
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003698option independent-streams
3699no option independent-streams
3700 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3702 yes | yes | yes | yes
3703 Arguments : none
3704
3705 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3706 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3707 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3708 receive data or not.
3709
3710 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3711 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3712 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3713 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3714 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3715 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3716 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3717 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3718 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3719 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3720 socket buffers.
3721
3722 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3723 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3724 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3725 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3726 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3727
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003728 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
3729 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
3730 deprecated.
3731
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003732 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003733
3734
Simon Hormana2b9dad2013-02-12 10:45:54 +09003735option lb-agent-chk
3736 Use a TCP connection to obtain a metric of server health
3737 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3738 yes | no | yes | yes
3739 Arguments : none
3740
3741 This alters health checking behaviour by connecting making a TCP
3742 connection and reading an ASCII string. The string should have one of
3743 the following forms:
3744
3745 * An ASCII representation of an positive integer percentage.
3746 e.g. "75%"
3747
3748 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
3749 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts.
3750
3751 * The string "drain".
3752
3753 This will cause the weight of a server to be set to 0, and thus it will
3754 not accept any new connections other than those that are accepted via
3755 persistence.
3756
3757 * The string "down", optionally followed by a description string.
3758
3759 Mark the server as down and log the description string as the reason.
3760
3761 * The string "stopped", optionally followed by a description string.
3762
3763 This currently has the same behaviour as down (iii).
3764
3765 * The string "fail", optionally followed by a description string.
3766
3767 This currently has the same behaviour as down (iii).
3768
3769 The use of an alternate check-port, used to obtain agent heath check
3770 information described above as opposed to the port of the service, may be
3771 useful in conjunction with this option.
3772
3773
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003774option ldap-check
3775 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3776 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3777 yes | no | yes | yes
3778 Arguments : none
3779
3780 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3781 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3782 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3783 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3784
3785 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3786 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3787
3788 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3789 configure it.
3790
3791 Example :
3792 option ldap-check
3793
3794 See also : "option httpchk"
3795
3796
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003797option log-health-checks
3798no option log-health-checks
3799 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3801 yes | no | yes | yes
3802 Arguments : none
3803
3804 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3805 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3806 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3807 of additional information is limited.
3808
3809 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3810 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3811
3812 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3813
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003814
3815option log-separate-errors
3816no option log-separate-errors
3817 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3818 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3819 yes | yes | yes | no
3820 Arguments : none
3821
3822 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3823 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3824 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3825 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3826 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3827 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3828 provides very important information.
3829
3830 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3831 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3832 error logs.
3833
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003834 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003835 logging.
3836
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003837
3838option logasap
3839no option logasap
3840 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3841 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3842 yes | yes | yes | no
3843 Arguments : none
3844
3845 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3846 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3847 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3848 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3849 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3850 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3851 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003852 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003853 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3854 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3855
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003856 Examples :
3857 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3858 mode http
3859 option httplog
3860 option logasap
3861 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3862
3863 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3864 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3865 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3866 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3867
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003868 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003869 logging.
3870
3871
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003872option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3873 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3875 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003876 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003877 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
3878 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003879
3880 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3881 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3882 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3883 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3884 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3885 in the MySQL table, like this :
3886
3887 USE mysql;
3888 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3889 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3890
3891 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3892 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3893 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3894 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3895 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3896 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3897 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3898 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3899 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3900
3901 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3902 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003903
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02003904 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003905
3906 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3907 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3908 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3909 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3910 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3911 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3912
3913 See also: "option httpchk"
3914
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003915option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
3916 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
3917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3918 yes | no | yes | yes
3919 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003920 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
3921 PostgreSQL server.
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003922
3923 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
3924 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
3925 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
3926 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
3927
3928 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003929
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003930option nolinger
3931no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003932 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003933 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3934 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003935 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003936
3937 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3938 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3939 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3940 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3941 connections.
3942
3943 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3944 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3945 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3946 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3947 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3948 this too.
3949
3950 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3951 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3952 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3953
3954 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3955 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3956 for servers.
3957
3958 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3959 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3960
3961
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003962option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3963 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3965 yes | yes | yes | yes
3966 Arguments :
3967 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3968 matching <network>
3969 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3970 header name.
3971
3972 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3973 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3974 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3975 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3976 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3977 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3978 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3979 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3980 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3981 possible that the client has already brought one.
3982
3983 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3984 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3985 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3986 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3987 header and requires different one.
3988
3989 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3990 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3991 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3992 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3993 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3994 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3995 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3996
3997 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3998 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3999 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4000 both are defined.
4001
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004002 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
4003 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
4004 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
4005 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
4006 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004007
4008 Examples :
4009 # Original Destination address
4010 frontend www
4011 mode http
4012 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4013
4014 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4015 backend www
4016 mode http
4017 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4018
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004019 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4020 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004021
4022
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004023option persist
4024no option persist
4025 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4026 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4027 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004028 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004029
4030 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4031 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4032 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4033 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4034 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4035 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4036 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4037 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4038 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4039 redirected to another valid server.
4040
4041 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4042 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4043
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004044 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004045
4046
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004047option redispatch
4048no option redispatch
4049 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4050 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4051 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004052 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004053
4054 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4055 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4056 be able to access the service anymore.
4057
4058 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4059 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4060
4061 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4062 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4063 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004064
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004065 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4066 "redisp" keywords.
4067
4068 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4069 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4070
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004071 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004072
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004073
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004074option redis-check
4075 Use redis health checks for server testing
4076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4077 yes | no | yes | yes
4078 Arguments : none
4079
4080 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4081 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4082 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4083 find the "+PONG" response message.
4084
4085 Example :
4086 option redis-check
4087
4088 See also : "option httpchk"
4089
4090
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004091option smtpchk
4092option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4093 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4095 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004096 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004097 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4098 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4099 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4100
4101 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4102 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4103 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4104
4105 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4106 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4107 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4108 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4109 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4110 dead server.
4111
4112 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4113 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4114 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4115 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4116
4117 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4118 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4119 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4120 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4121 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4122
4123 Example :
4124 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4125
4126 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4127
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004128
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004129option socket-stats
4130no option socket-stats
4131
4132 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4134 yes | yes | yes | no
4135
4136 Arguments : none
4137
4138
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004139option splice-auto
4140no option splice-auto
4141 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4142 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4143 yes | yes | yes | yes
4144 Arguments : none
4145
4146 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4147 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4148 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4149 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004150 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004151 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4152 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4153 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4154 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4155
4156 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4157 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4158 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4159 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4160 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4161 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4162 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4163 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4164 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4165 keyword.
4166
4167 Example :
4168 option splice-auto
4169
4170 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4171 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4172
4173 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4174 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4175
4176
4177option splice-request
4178no option splice-request
4179 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4180 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4181 yes | yes | yes | yes
4182 Arguments : none
4183
4184 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004185 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004186 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4187 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4188 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4189 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4190
4191 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4192
4193 Example :
4194 option splice-request
4195
4196 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4197 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4198
4199 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4200 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4201
4202
4203option splice-response
4204no option splice-response
4205 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4207 yes | yes | yes | yes
4208 Arguments : none
4209
4210 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004211 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004212 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4213 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4214 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4215 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4216
4217 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4218
4219 Example :
4220 option splice-response
4221
4222 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4223 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4224
4225 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4226 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4227
4228
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004229option srvtcpka
4230no option srvtcpka
4231 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4233 yes | no | yes | yes
4234 Arguments : none
4235
4236 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4237 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4238 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4239 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4240
4241 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4242 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4243 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4244 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4245
4246 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4247 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4248 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4249 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4250 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4251
4252 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4253
4254 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4255 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4256 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4257
4258 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4259 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4260
4261 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4262
4263
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004264option ssl-hello-chk
4265 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4267 yes | no | yes | yes
4268 Arguments : none
4269
4270 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4271 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4272 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4273 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4274 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4275 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4276 hello message.
4277
4278 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4279 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4280 messages, which is appreciable.
4281
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004282 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4283 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4284 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004285
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004286 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4287
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004288
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004289option tcp-smart-accept
4290no option tcp-smart-accept
4291 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4293 yes | yes | yes | no
4294 Arguments : none
4295
4296 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4297 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4298 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4299 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4300 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4301 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4302
4303 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4304 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4305 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4306 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4307
4308 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4309 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4310 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4311 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4312
4313 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4314 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4315 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4316
4317 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4318 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4319 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4320
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004321 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4322
4323
4324option tcp-smart-connect
4325no option tcp-smart-connect
4326 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4328 yes | no | yes | yes
4329 Arguments : none
4330
4331 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4332 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4333 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4334 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4335 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4336
4337 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4338 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4339 complex.
4340
4341 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4342 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4343 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4344
4345 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4346 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4347
4348 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4349
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004350
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004351option tcpka
4352 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4354 yes | yes | yes | yes
4355 Arguments : none
4356
4357 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4358 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4359 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4360 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4361
4362 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4363 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4364 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4365 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4366
4367 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4368 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4369 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4370 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4371 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4372
4373 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4374
4375 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4376 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4377 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4378 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4379 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4380 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4381 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4382 backends.
4383
4384 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4385
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004386
4387option tcplog
4388 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4390 yes | yes | yes | yes
4391 Arguments : none
4392
4393 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4394 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4395 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4396 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4397 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4398 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4399 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4400 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4401
4402 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4403
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004404 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004405
4406
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004407option transparent
4408no option transparent
4409 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004411 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004412 Arguments : none
4413
4414 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4415 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4416 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4417 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4418 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4419 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4420 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4421 appropriate server.
4422
4423 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4424 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4425
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004426 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004427 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004428
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004429
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004430persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004431persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004432 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4433 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4434 yes | no | yes | yes
4435 Arguments :
4436 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004437 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4438 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004439
4440 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4441 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4442 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4443 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4444 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4445 forwarded to this server.
4446
4447 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4448 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4449 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004450 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004451 a single "listen" section.
4452
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004453 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4454 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4455 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4456
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004457 Example :
4458 listen tse-farm
4459 bind :3389
4460 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4461 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4462 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4463 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4464 persist rdp-cookie
4465 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004466 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004467 balance rdp-cookie
4468 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4469 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4470
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004471 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4472 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004473
4474
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004475rate-limit sessions <rate>
4476 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4478 yes | yes | yes | no
4479 Arguments :
4480 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4481 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4482
4483 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4484 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4485 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4486 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4487 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4488 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4489
4490 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4491 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4492 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4493 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4494
4495 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4496 listen smtp
4497 mode tcp
4498 bind :25
4499 rate-limit sessions 10
4500 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4501
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004502 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4503 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4504 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004505
4506 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4507
4508
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004509redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4510redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4511redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004512 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4514 no | yes | yes | yes
4515
4516 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004517 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004518
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004519 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004520 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
4521 the HTTP "Location" header.
4522
4523 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
4524 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
4525 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
4526 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
4527 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
4528 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie).
4529
4530 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
4531 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
4532 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
4533 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
4534 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
4535 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
4536 returned, which most recent browsers interprete as redirecting to
4537 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
4538 HTTPS.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004539
4540 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4541 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4542 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4543 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4544 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4545 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4546 location with a GET method.
4547
4548 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4549 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4550
4551 - "drop-query"
4552 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4553 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4554 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4555 with a location-type redirect.
4556
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004557 - "append-slash"
4558 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4559 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4560 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4561 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4562
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004563 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4564 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4565 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4566 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4567 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4568 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4569 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4570
4571 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4572 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4573 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4574 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4575 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4576 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4577 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004578
4579 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4580 acl clear dst_port 80
4581 acl secure dst_port 8080
4582 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004583 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004584 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004585 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4586
4587 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004588 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4589 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4590 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004591 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004592
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004593 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4594 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4595 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4596
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004597 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01004598 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004599
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004600 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004601
4602
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004603redisp (deprecated)
4604redispatch (deprecated)
4605 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4606 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4607 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004608 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004609
4610 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4611 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4612 be able to access the service anymore.
4613
4614 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4615 redistribute them to a working server.
4616
4617 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4618 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4619 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004620
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004621 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4622 "option redispatch" instead.
4623
4624 See also : "option redispatch"
4625
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004626
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004627reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004628 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4630 no | yes | yes | yes
4631 Arguments :
4632 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4633 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004634 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004635
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004636 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4637 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4638
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004639 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4640 the last header of an HTTP request.
4641
4642 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4643 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4644 responses.
4645
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004646 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4647 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4648 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4649
4650 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4651 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004652
4653
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004654reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4655reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004656 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4658 no | yes | yes | yes
4659 Arguments :
4660 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4661 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4662 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4663 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4664 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4665 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4666 ignores case.
4667
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004668 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4669 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4670
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004671 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4672 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4673 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4674 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004675 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004676
4677 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4678 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4679
4680 Example :
4681 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4682 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4683 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4684
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004685 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4686 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004687
4688
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004689reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4690reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004691 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4693 no | yes | yes | yes
4694 Arguments :
4695 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4696 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4697 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4698 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4699 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4700 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4701
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004702 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4703 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4704
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004705 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4706 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4707 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4708 next servers.
4709
4710 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4711 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4712 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4713
4714 Example :
4715 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4716 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4717 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4718
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004719 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4720 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004721
4722
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004723reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4724reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004725 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4727 no | yes | yes | yes
4728 Arguments :
4729 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4730 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4731 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4732 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4733 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4734 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4735 case.
4736
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004737 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4738 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4739
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004740 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4741 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4742 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4743 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004744 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004745
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004746 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004747 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004748 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004749
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004750 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4751 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4752
4753 Example :
4754 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4755 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4756 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4757
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004758 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4759 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004760
4761
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004762reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4763reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004764 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4766 no | yes | yes | yes
4767 Arguments :
4768 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4769 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4770 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4771 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4772 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4773 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4774 case.
4775
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004776 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4777 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4778
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004779 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4780 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4781 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4782 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4783
4784 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4785 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4786
4787 Example :
4788 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4789 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4790 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4791 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4792
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004793 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4794 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004795
4796
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004797reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4798reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004799 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4801 no | yes | yes | yes
4802 Arguments :
4803 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4804 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4805 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4806 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4807 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4808 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4809
4810 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4811 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4812 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4813 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004814 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004815
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004816 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4817 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4818
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004819 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4820 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4821 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4822
4823 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4824 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4825 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4826 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4827 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4828
4829 Example :
4830 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04004831 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004832 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4833 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4834
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04004835 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
4836 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004837
4838
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004839reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4840reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004841 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4843 no | yes | yes | yes
4844 Arguments :
4845 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4846 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4847 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4848 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4849 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4850 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4851 ignores case.
4852
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004853 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4854 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4855
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004856 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4857 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004858 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4859 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4860 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004861 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4862 not set.
4863
4864 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4865 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4866 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4867 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4868 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4869
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004870 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004871 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4872 # block all others.
4873 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4874 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4875
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004876 # block bad guys
4877 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4878 reqitarpit . if badguys
4879
4880 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4881 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004882
4883
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004884retries <value>
4885 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4886 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4887 yes | no | yes | yes
4888 Arguments :
4889 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4890 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4891 default value is 3.
4892
4893 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4894 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4895 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4896
4897 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4898 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4899
4900 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4901 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4902
4903 See also : "option redispatch"
4904
4905
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004906rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004907 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4909 no | yes | yes | yes
4910 Arguments :
4911 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4912 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004913 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004914
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004915 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4916 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4917
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004918 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4919 the last header of an HTTP response.
4920
4921 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4922 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4923 responses.
4924
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004925 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4926 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004927
4928
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004929rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4930rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004931 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4933 no | yes | yes | yes
4934 Arguments :
4935 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4936 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4937 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4938 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4939 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4940 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4941 ignores case.
4942
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004943 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4944 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4945
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004946 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4947 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004948 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004949 client.
4950
4951 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4952 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4953 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4954
4955 Example :
4956 # remove the Server header from responses
4957 reqidel ^Server:.*
4958
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004959 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4960 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004961
4962
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004963rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4964rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004965 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4967 no | yes | yes | yes
4968 Arguments :
4969 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4970 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4971 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4972 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4973 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4974 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4975 ignores case.
4976
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004977 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4978 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4979
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004980 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4981 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4982 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4983 case-sensitive.
4984
4985 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004986 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4987 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4988 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004989
4990 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4991 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4992
4993 Example :
4994 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4995 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4996
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004997 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4998 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004999
5000
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005001rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5002rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005003 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5004 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5005 no | yes | yes | yes
5006 Arguments :
5007 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5008 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5009 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5010 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5011 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5012 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5013 ignores case.
5014
5015 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5016 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5017 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5018 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005019 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005020
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005021 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5022 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5023
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005024 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5025 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5026 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5027
5028 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5029 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5030 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5031 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5032 are not case-sensitive.
5033
5034 Example :
5035 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5036 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5037
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005038 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5039 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005040
5041
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005042server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005043 Declare a server in a backend
5044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5045 no | no | yes | yes
5046 Arguments :
5047 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005048 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005049 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005050
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005051 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5052 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5053 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5054 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005055 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5056 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5057 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5058 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5059 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
5060 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005061
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005062 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005063 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5064 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5065 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5066 adding this value to the client's port.
5067
5068 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5069 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005070 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005071
5072 Examples :
5073 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5074 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
5075
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005076 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5077 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005078
5079
5080source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005081source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005082source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005083 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5085 yes | no | yes | yes
5086 Arguments :
5087 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5088 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
5089 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
5090 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
5091
5092 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5093 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005094 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5095 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5096 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005097
5098 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5099 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5100 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5101 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5102 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5103 <addr>.
5104
5105 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5106 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5107 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5108 port.
5109
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005110 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
5111 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5112 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5113 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01005114 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005115 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5116 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5117 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
5118 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
5119 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
5120 HTTP header.
5121
5122 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
5123 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005124 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005125 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
5126 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
5127 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
5128 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
5129 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
5130 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
5131 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
5132
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005133 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
5134 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
5135 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
5136 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
5137 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
5138 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
5139
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005140 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
5141 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
5142 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
5143 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
5144
5145 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
5146 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
5147 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
5148 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
5149 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
5150 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
5151
5152 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
5153 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
5154 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
5155 there are two methods :
5156
5157 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
5158 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
5159 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
5160 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
5161 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
5162 of the client ranges may be used.
5163
5164 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
5165 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
5166 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
5167 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
5168 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
5169 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
5170 same session.
5171
5172 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
5173 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
5174 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
5175 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
5176 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
5177 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
5178
5179 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
5180 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
5181 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005182 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005183
5184 Examples :
5185 backend private
5186 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
5187 source 192.168.1.200
5188
5189 backend transparent_ssl1
5190 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
5191 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5192
5193 backend transparent_ssl2
5194 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5195 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5196 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5197
5198 backend transparent_ssl3
5199 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5200 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5201 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5202
5203 backend transparent_smtp
5204 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5205 # with Tproxy version 4.
5206 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5207
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005208 backend transparent_http
5209 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5210 # proxy.
5211 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5212
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005213 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005214 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5215
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005216
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005217srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5218 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5220 yes | no | yes | yes
5221 Arguments :
5222 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5223 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5224 as explained at the top of this document.
5225
5226 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5227 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5228 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5229 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5230 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5231 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5232 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5233
5234 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5235 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5236 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5237 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5238 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005239 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005240 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005241 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005242
5243 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5244 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5245 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5246 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5247 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5248 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5249
5250 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5251 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5252
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005253 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5254 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005255
5256
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005257stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5258 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5260 no | no | yes | yes
5261
5262 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5263 matched.
5264
5265 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5266 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5267
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005268 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5269 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5270 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5271
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005272 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5273 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5274 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5275 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005276
5277 Example :
5278 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5279 backend stats_localhost
5280 stats enable
5281 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5282
5283 Example :
5284 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5285 backend stats_auth
5286 stats enable
5287 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5288 stats admin if TRUE
5289
5290 Example :
5291 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5292 userlist stats-auth
5293 group admin users admin
5294 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5295 group readonly users haproxy
5296 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5297
5298 backend stats_auth
5299 stats enable
5300 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5301 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5302 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5303 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5304
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005305 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5306 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5307 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005308
5309
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005310stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5311 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5313 yes | no | yes | yes
5314 Arguments :
5315 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5316
5317 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5318
5319 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5320 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5321 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5322 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5323 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5324 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5325
5326 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5327 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5328 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005329 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005330
5331 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5332 report using "stats scope".
5333
5334 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5335 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5336 unobvious parameters.
5337
5338 Example :
5339 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5340 backend public_www
5341 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5342 stats enable
5343 stats hide-version
5344 stats scope .
5345 stats uri /admin?stats
5346 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5347 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5348 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5349
5350 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5351 backend private_monitoring
5352 stats enable
5353 stats uri /admin?stats
5354 stats refresh 5s
5355
5356 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5357
5358
5359stats enable
5360 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5362 yes | no | yes | yes
5363 Arguments : none
5364
5365 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5366 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5367 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5368 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5369 - stats auth : no authentication
5370 - stats scope : no restriction
5371
5372 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5373 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5374 unobvious parameters.
5375
5376 Example :
5377 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5378 backend public_www
5379 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5380 stats enable
5381 stats hide-version
5382 stats scope .
5383 stats uri /admin?stats
5384 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5385 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5386 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5387
5388 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5389 backend private_monitoring
5390 stats enable
5391 stats uri /admin?stats
5392 stats refresh 5s
5393
5394 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5395
5396
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005397stats hide-version
5398 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5400 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005401 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005402
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005403 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5404 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5405 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5406 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5407 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5408 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005409
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005410 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5411 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5412 unobvious parameters.
5413
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005414 Example :
5415 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5416 backend public_www
5417 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005418 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005419 stats hide-version
5420 stats scope .
5421 stats uri /admin?stats
5422 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5423 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5424 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005425
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005426 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5427 backend private_monitoring
5428 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005429 stats uri /admin?stats
5430 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005431
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005432 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005433
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005434
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005435stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5436 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5437 Access control for statistics
5438
5439 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5440 no | no | yes | yes
5441
5442 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5443 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5444 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5445 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5446 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5447 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5448
5449 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5450 instance.
5451
5452 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5453 about ACL usage.
5454
5455
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005456stats realm <realm>
5457 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5459 yes | no | yes | yes
5460 Arguments :
5461 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5462 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5463 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5464
5465 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5466 using a backslash ('\').
5467
5468 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5469 only related to authentication.
5470
5471 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5472 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5473 unobvious parameters.
5474
5475 Example :
5476 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5477 backend public_www
5478 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5479 stats enable
5480 stats hide-version
5481 stats scope .
5482 stats uri /admin?stats
5483 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5484 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5485 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5486
5487 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5488 backend private_monitoring
5489 stats enable
5490 stats uri /admin?stats
5491 stats refresh 5s
5492
5493 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5494
5495
5496stats refresh <delay>
5497 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5499 yes | no | yes | yes
5500 Arguments :
5501 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5502 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5503 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5504 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5505 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5506 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5507
5508 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5509 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5510 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5511 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5512
5513 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5514 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5515 unobvious parameters.
5516
5517 Example :
5518 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5519 backend public_www
5520 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5521 stats enable
5522 stats hide-version
5523 stats scope .
5524 stats uri /admin?stats
5525 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5526 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5527 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5528
5529 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5530 backend private_monitoring
5531 stats enable
5532 stats uri /admin?stats
5533 stats refresh 5s
5534
5535 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5536
5537
5538stats scope { <name> | "." }
5539 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5541 yes | no | yes | yes
5542 Arguments :
5543 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5544 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5545 section in which the statement appears.
5546
5547 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5548 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5549 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5550 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5551 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5552 exists.
5553
5554 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5555 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5556 unobvious parameters.
5557
5558 Example :
5559 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5560 backend public_www
5561 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5562 stats enable
5563 stats hide-version
5564 stats scope .
5565 stats uri /admin?stats
5566 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5567 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5568 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5569
5570 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5571 backend private_monitoring
5572 stats enable
5573 stats uri /admin?stats
5574 stats refresh 5s
5575
5576 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5577
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005578
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005579stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005580 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5582 yes | no | yes | yes
5583
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005584 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005585 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5586
5587 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5588 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5589
5590 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5591 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005592 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005593
5594 Example :
5595 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5596 backend private_monitoring
5597 stats enable
5598 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5599 stats uri /admin?stats
5600 stats refresh 5s
5601
5602 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5603 global section.
5604
5605
5606stats show-legends
5607 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5608 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5609 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5610 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5611 - IP (socket, server)
5612 - cookie (backend, server)
5613
5614 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5615 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005616 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005617
5618 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5619
5620
5621stats show-node [ <name> ]
5622 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5624 yes | no | yes | yes
5625 Arguments:
5626 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5627 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5628
5629 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5630 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005631 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005632
5633 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5634 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5635 unobvious parameters.
5636
5637 Example:
5638 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5639 backend private_monitoring
5640 stats enable
5641 stats show-node Europe-1
5642 stats uri /admin?stats
5643 stats refresh 5s
5644
5645 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5646 section.
5647
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005648
5649stats uri <prefix>
5650 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5652 yes | no | yes | yes
5653 Arguments :
5654 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5655 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5656 query string.
5657
5658 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5659 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5660 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5661 possible to reach it in the application.
5662
5663 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005664 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005665 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5666 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5667 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5668 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5669
5670 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5671 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5672 an address or a port to statistics only.
5673
5674 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5675 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5676 unobvious parameters.
5677
5678 Example :
5679 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5680 backend public_www
5681 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5682 stats enable
5683 stats hide-version
5684 stats scope .
5685 stats uri /admin?stats
5686 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5687 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5688 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5689
5690 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5691 backend private_monitoring
5692 stats enable
5693 stats uri /admin?stats
5694 stats refresh 5s
5695
5696 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5697
5698
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005699stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5700 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005702 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005703
5704 Arguments :
5705 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5706 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5707 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5708 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5709
5710 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5711 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5712 the "stick-table" statement.
5713
5714 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5715 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5716 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5717 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5718 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5719
5720 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5721 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5722 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5723 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5724 transformation rules.
5725
5726 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5727 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5728 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5729 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5730 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5731 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5732 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5733
5734 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5735 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5736 ACL based conditions.
5737
5738 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5739 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5740 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5741 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5742
5743 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5744 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5745 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5746 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5747
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005748 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5749 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5750 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5751
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005752 Example :
5753 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5754 # last 30 minutes
5755 backend pop
5756 mode tcp
5757 balance roundrobin
5758 stick store-request src
5759 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5760 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5761 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5762
5763 backend smtp
5764 mode tcp
5765 balance roundrobin
5766 stick match src table pop
5767 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5768 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5769
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005770 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5771 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005772
5773
5774stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5775 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5776 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5777 no | no | yes | yes
5778
5779 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5780 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5781 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5782 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5783
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005784 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5785 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5786 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5787
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005788 Examples :
5789 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005790 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005791
5792 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5793 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5794 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5795
5796
5797 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5798 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5799 backend http
5800 mode http
5801 balance roundrobin
5802 stick on src table https
5803 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5804 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5805 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5806
5807 backend https
5808 mode tcp
5809 balance roundrobin
5810 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5811 stick on src
5812 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5813 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5814
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005815 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005816
5817
5818stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5819 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5821 no | no | yes | yes
5822
5823 Arguments :
5824 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5825 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5826 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5827 server is selected.
5828
5829 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5830 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5831 the "stick-table" statement.
5832
5833 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5834 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5835 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5836 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5837 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5838 address.
5839
5840 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5841 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5842 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5843 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5844 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5845 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5846 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5847 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5848 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5849 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5850
5851 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5852 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5853 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5854 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5855 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5856 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5857 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5858
5859 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5860 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5861 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5862 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5863
5864 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5865 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5866 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5867 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5868 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5869 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5870 another protocol or access method.
5871
5872 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5873 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5874 the request.
5875
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005876 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5877 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5878 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5879
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005880 Example :
5881 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5882 # last 30 minutes
5883 backend pop
5884 mode tcp
5885 balance roundrobin
5886 stick store-request src
5887 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5888 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5889 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5890
5891 backend smtp
5892 mode tcp
5893 balance roundrobin
5894 stick match src table pop
5895 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5896 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5897
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005898 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5899 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005900
5901
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005902stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005903 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5904 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005905 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5906 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005907 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005908
5909 Arguments :
5910 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5911 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5912 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5913 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5914
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01005915 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
5916 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
5917 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5918 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5919
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005920 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5921 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5922 instance.
5923
5924 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5925 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5926 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5927 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5928 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5929 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005930 to 32 characters.
5931
5932 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5933 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5934 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5935 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5936 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5937 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005938
5939 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005940 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5941 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005942 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5943 increase.
5944
5945 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005946 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5947 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5948 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005949
5950 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5951 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5952 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5953 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5954 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5955 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5956 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5957 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5958 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5959 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5960 parameter (see below).
5961
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005962 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5963 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5964 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5965 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5966 soft restart.
5967
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005968 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
5969
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005970 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5971 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5972 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5973 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5974 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005975 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005976 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5977 if not expiration delay is specified.
5978
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005979 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5980 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5981 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5982 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005983 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5984 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5985 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5986 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5987 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5988 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5989 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5990 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5991 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5992 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5993 types and their arguments.
5994
5995 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5996 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5997 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5998 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5999
6000 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6001 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6002 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6003 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6004
6005 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6006 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6007 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6008 they were received.
6009
6010 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6011 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6012 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6013 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6014 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6015
6016 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6017 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6018 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6019 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6020 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6021
6022 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6023 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6024 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6025
6026 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6027 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6028 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6029 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6030 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6031
6032 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6033 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6034 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6035 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6036 the client side.
6037
6038 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6039 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6040 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6041 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6042 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6043 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6044 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6045
6046 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6047 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6048 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6049 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6050 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6051 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6052 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6053
6054 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6055 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6056 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6057 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6058 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6059 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6060
6061 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6062 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6063 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6064 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6065
6066 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6067 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6068 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6069 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6070 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6071 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6072 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6073 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6074 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6075 recommended for better fairness.
6076
6077 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6078 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6079 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6080 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6081
6082 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6083 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6084 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6085 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6086 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6087 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6088 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6089 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6090 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6091 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006092
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006093 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
6094 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006095 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
6096 reference it.
6097
6098 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
6099 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
6100 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
6101 as an exclusive stickiness.
6102
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006103 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
6104 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
6105 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
6106 something that can be ignored.
6107
6108 Example:
6109 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
6110 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
6111 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
6112 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
6113
6114 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01006115 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006116
6117
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006118stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6119 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6121 no | no | yes | yes
6122
6123 Arguments :
6124 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
6125 describes what elements of the response or connection will
6126 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6127 server is selected.
6128
6129 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6130 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6131 the "stick-table" statement.
6132
6133 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6134 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6135 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
6136 when the response is a SSL server hello.
6137
6138 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6139 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
6140 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
6141 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
6142 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
6143 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006144 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006145 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
6146 rules.
6147
6148 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6149 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6150 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6151 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6152 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6153 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6154 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6155
6156 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
6157 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6158 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
6159 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6160
6161 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
6162 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6163 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6164 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6165 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6166 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
6167 another protocol or access method.
6168
6169 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
6170
6171 Example :
6172 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
6173 backend https
6174 mode tcp
6175 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006176 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006177 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006178
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006179 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
6180 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
6181
6182 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
6183 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6184 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
6185
6186 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
6187 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006188
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006189 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
6190 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
6191 # at offset 44.
6192
6193 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6194 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6195
6196 # Learn on response if server hello.
6197 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006198
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006199 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6200 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6201
6202 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6203 extraction.
6204
6205
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006206tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6207 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006208 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6209 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006210 Arguments :
6211 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6212 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6213 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006214
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006215 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006216
6217 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
6218 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006219 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
6220 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
6221 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
6222 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
6223 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
6224 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006225
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006226 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
6227 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
6228 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
6229 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006230
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006231 Three types of actions are supported :
6232 - accept :
6233 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6234 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6235 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006236
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006237 - reject :
6238 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6239 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6240 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6241 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
6242 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
6243 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
6244 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
6245 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6246 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6247 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6248 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6249 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006250
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006251 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
6252 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
6253 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
6254 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
6255 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
6256 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
6257 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
6258 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
6259 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006260
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006261 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006262 <key> is mandatory, and is a pattern extraction rule as described
6263 in section 7.8. It describes what elements of the incoming
6264 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
6265 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
6266 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
6267 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006268
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006269 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6270 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6271 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6272 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006273
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006274 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6275 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6276 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6277 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6278 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006279 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
6280 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
6281 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
6282 layer7 information is extracted.
6283
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006284 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6285 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6286 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6287 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6288 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006289
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006290 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6291 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6292 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006293
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006294 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6295 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6296 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006297
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006298 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006299 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006300 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006301
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006302 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6303 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6304 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006305
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006306 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
6307 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6308 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006309
6310 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6311
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006312 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006313
6314
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006315tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6316 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006318 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006319 Arguments :
6320 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6321 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6322 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006323
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006324 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006325
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006326 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6327 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6328 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6329 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6330 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006331
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006332 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6333 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6334 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6335 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6336 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6337 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6338 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6339 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6340 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006341
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006342 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6343 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6344 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6345 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006346
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006347 Three types of actions are supported :
6348 - accept :
6349 - reject :
6350 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006351
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006352 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6353 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006354
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006355 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6356 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6357 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006358 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. This makes a subtle
6359 difference because tracking rules in "frontend" and "listen" section last for
6360 all the session, as opposed to the backend rules. The difference appears when
6361 some layer 7 information is tracked. While there is nothing mandatory about
6362 it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track per-frontend
6363 counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006364
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006365 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006366 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6367 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006368
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006369 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006370 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
6371 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
6372 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
6373 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
6374 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006375
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006376 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
6377 are present when the rule is processed. The current solution for making the
6378 rule engine wait for such information is to set an inspect delay and to
6379 condition its execution with an ACL relying on such information.
6380
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006381 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006382 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6383 # and reject everything else.
6384 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6385 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006386 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006387 tcp-request content reject
6388
6389 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006390 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6391 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6392 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006393 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006394
6395 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6396 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6397 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006398 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006399 tcp-request content reject
6400
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006401 Example:
6402 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
6403 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
6404 tcp-request content track-sc1 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1) if HTTP
6405
6406 Example:
6407 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
6408 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
6409 tcp-request content track-sc1 base table req-rate if HTTP
6410
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006411 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6412 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6413
6414 frontend http
6415 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
6416 # protecting all our sites
6417 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
6418 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6419 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
6420 ...
6421 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6422
6423 backend http_dynamic
6424 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
6425 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
6426 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
6427 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01006428 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006429 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
6430 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006431
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006432 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006433
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006434 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006435
6436
6437tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6438 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006440 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006441 Arguments :
6442 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6443 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6444 as explained at the top of this document.
6445
6446 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6447 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6448 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6449 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6450 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6451
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006452 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6453 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6454 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6455 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6456
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006457 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6458 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006459 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006460 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006461 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6462 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6463 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6464 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006465
6466 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6467 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6468 it pass through unaffected.
6469
6470 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6471 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6472 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006473 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006474 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6475 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006476 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6477 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6478 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006479
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006480 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006481 "timeout client".
6482
6483
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006484tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6485 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6487 no | no | yes | yes
6488 Arguments :
6489 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6490 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6491 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6492
6493 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6494
6495 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6496 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6497 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6498 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006499 set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006500
6501 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6502
6503 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6504 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6505 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6506 inserted.
6507
6508 Two types of actions are supported :
6509 - accept :
6510 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6511 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6512 the rules evaluation.
6513
6514 - reject :
6515 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6516 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006517 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006518
6519 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6520 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6521 for changing the default action to a reject.
6522
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006523 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
6524 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
6525 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
6526 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006527 period.
6528
6529 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6530
6531 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6532
6533
6534tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6535 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6537 no | no | yes | yes
6538 Arguments :
6539 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6540 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6541 as explained at the top of this document.
6542
6543 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6544
6545
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006546timeout check <timeout>
6547 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6548 established.
6549
6550 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6551 yes | no | yes | yes
6552 Arguments:
6553 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6554 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6555 as explained at the top of this document.
6556
6557 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6558 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6559 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6560 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006561 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6562 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6563 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006564
6565 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6566 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6567
6568 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6569 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006570 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006571
6572 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6573 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6574 forget about it.
6575
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006576 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6577 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006578
6579
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006580timeout client <timeout>
6581timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6582 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6584 yes | yes | yes | no
6585 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006586 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006587 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6588 as explained at the top of this document.
6589
6590 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6591 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6592 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6593 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6594 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6595 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6596 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6597 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006598 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006599 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006600 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
6601 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
6602 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006603
6604 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6605 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6606 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6607 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6608 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6609 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6610
6611 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6612 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6613 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6614
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006615 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006616
6617
6618timeout connect <timeout>
6619timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6620 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6622 yes | no | yes | yes
6623 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006624 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006625 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6626 as explained at the top of this document.
6627
6628 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006629 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006630 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006631 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006632 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6633 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006634
6635 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6636 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6637 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6638 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6639 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6640 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6641
6642 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6643 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6644 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6645
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006646 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6647 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006648
6649
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006650timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6651 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6653 yes | yes | yes | yes
6654 Arguments :
6655 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6656 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6657 as explained at the top of this document.
6658
6659 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6660 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6661 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6662 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6663 once the request has started to present itself.
6664
6665 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6666 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6667 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6668 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6669 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6670
6671 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6672 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6673 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6674 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6675
6676 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6677 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6678 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6679 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6680 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006681 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006682
6683 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6684 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6685 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6686 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6687
6688 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6689
6690
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006691timeout http-request <timeout>
6692 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006694 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006695 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006696 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006697 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6698 as explained at the top of this document.
6699
6700 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6701 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6702 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6703 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6704 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6705 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6706 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6707 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6708
6709 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6710 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006711 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6712 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006713
6714 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6715 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6716 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6717 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6718 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6719
6720 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006721 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6722 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6723 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006724
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006725 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006726
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006727
6728timeout queue <timeout>
6729 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6731 yes | no | yes | yes
6732 Arguments :
6733 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6734 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6735 as explained at the top of this document.
6736
6737 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6738 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6739 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6740 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6741 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6742
6743 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6744 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6745 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6746 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6747
6748 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6749
6750
6751timeout server <timeout>
6752timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6753 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6755 yes | no | yes | yes
6756 Arguments :
6757 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6758 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6759 as explained at the top of this document.
6760
6761 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6762 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6763 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6764 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6765 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6766 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6767 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6768
6769 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6770 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6771 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6772 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6773 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006774 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006775 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006776 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
6777 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
6778 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
6779 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006780
6781 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6782 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6783 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6784 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6785 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6786 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6787
6788 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6789 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6790 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6791
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006792 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006793
6794
6795timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006796 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6798 yes | yes | yes | yes
6799 Arguments :
6800 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6801 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6802 as explained at the top of this document.
6803
6804 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6805 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6806 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6807
6808 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6809 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6810 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6811 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006812 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006813
6814 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6815
6816
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006817timeout tunnel <timeout>
6818 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
6819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6820 yes | no | yes | yes
6821 Arguments :
6822 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6823 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6824 as explained at the top of this document.
6825
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006826 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006827 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
6828 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
6829 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
6830 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
6831 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
6832 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
6833 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
6834 specified.
6835
6836 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6837 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6838 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
6839 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
6840 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
6841
6842 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6843 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6844 forget about it.
6845
6846 Example :
6847 defaults http
6848 option http-server-close
6849 timeout connect 5s
6850 timeout client 30s
6851 timeout client 30s
6852 timeout server 30s
6853 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
6854
6855 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
6856
6857
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006858transparent (deprecated)
6859 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006861 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006862 Arguments : none
6863
6864 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6865 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6866 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6867 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6868 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6869 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6870 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6871 appropriate server.
6872
6873 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6874
6875 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6876 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6877
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006878 See also: "option transparent"
6879
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006880unique-id-format <string>
6881 Generate a unique ID for each request.
6882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6883 yes | yes | yes | no
6884 Arguments :
6885 <string> is a log-format string.
6886
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006887 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
6888 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
6889 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
6890 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006891
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006892 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
6893 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
6894 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
6895 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
6896 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
6897 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
6898 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
6899 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006900
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006901 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
6902 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006903
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006904 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006905
6906 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6907
6908 will generate:
6909
6910 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6911
6912 See also: "unique-id-header"
6913
6914unique-id-header <name>
6915 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
6916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6917 yes | yes | yes | no
6918 Arguments :
6919 <name> is the name of the header.
6920
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006921 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
6922 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006923
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006924 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006925
6926 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6927 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
6928
6929 will generate:
6930
6931 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6932
6933 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006934
6935use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6936use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006937 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6939 no | yes | yes | no
6940 Arguments :
6941 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6942
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006943 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006944
6945 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6946 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6947 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006948 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6949 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6950 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6951 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006952
6953 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6954 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6955 assign the backend.
6956
6957 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6958 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6959 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6960 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6961 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6962 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6963
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006964 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006965 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006966 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6967 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6968 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6969
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006970 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006971
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006972
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006973use-server <server> if <condition>
6974use-server <server> unless <condition>
6975 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
6976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6977 no | no | yes | yes
6978 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006979 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006980
6981 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
6982
6983 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
6984 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
6985 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
6986
6987 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
6988 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
6989 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
6990 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
6991 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
6992 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
6993 matches will assign the server.
6994
6995 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
6996 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
6997 with the next rules until one matches.
6998
6999 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
7000 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7001 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
7002 according to other persistence mechanisms.
7003
7004 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
7005 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
7006 stripped.
7007
7008 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
7009 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
7010 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
7011 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
7012
7013 Example :
7014 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
7015 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
7016 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
7017 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
7018 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
7019 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
7020 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
7021 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
7022 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
7023
7024 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
7025
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007026
70275. Bind and Server options
7028--------------------------
7029
7030The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
7031depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
7032settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
7033written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
7034described in this section.
7035
7036
70375.1. Bind options
7038-----------------
7039
7040The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
7041as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
7042no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
7043parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
7044while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
7045provided immediately after the setting name.
7046
7047The currently supported settings are the following ones.
7048
7049accept-proxy
7050 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
7051 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
7052 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
7053 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
7054 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
7055 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
7056 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
7057 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
7058 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
7059 usable.
7060
7061backlog <backlog>
7062 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
7063 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
7064
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007065ecdhe <named curve>
7066 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
7067 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys and makes
7068 ECDHE cipher suites usable.
7069
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007070ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007071 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7072 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7073 client's certificate.
7074
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007075ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
7076 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7077 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
7078 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
7079 error is ignored.
7080
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007081ciphers <ciphers>
7082 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
7083 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
7084 negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
7085 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
7086 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
7087
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007088crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007089 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7090 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7091 to verify client's certificate.
7092
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007093crt <cert>
7094 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7095 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
7096 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02007097 files into one. If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters
7098 present in this file are also loaded. If a directory name is used instead of a
7099 PEM file, then all files found in that directory will be loaded. This
7100 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
7101 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
7102 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN
7103 or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is
7104 used instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007105 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org). If no SNI is provided by the
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02007106 client or if the SSL library does not support TLS extensions, or if the client
7107 provides and SNI which does not match any certificate, then the first loaded
7108 certificate will be presented. This means that when loading certificates from
7109 a directory, it is highly recommended to load the default one first as a file.
7110 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007111
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007112crt-ignore-err <errors>
7113 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7114 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0.
7115 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not abored if an
7116 error is ignored.
7117
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007118defer-accept
7119 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7120 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
7121 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
7122 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
7123 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
7124 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
7125 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
7126 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
7127 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
7128 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
7129 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
7130
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007131force-sslv3
7132 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7133 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
7134 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7135
7136force-tlsv10
7137 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7138 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7139
7140force-tlsv11
7141 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7142 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7143
7144force-tlsv12
7145 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7146 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7147
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007148gid <gid>
7149 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
7150 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7151 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
7152 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
7153 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7154
7155group <group>
7156 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
7157 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
7158 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
7159 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
7160 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7161
7162id <id>
7163 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
7164 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
7165 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
7166 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
7167
7168interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01007169 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
7170 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
7171 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
7172 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
7173 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
7174 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
7175 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007176
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02007177level <level>
7178 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
7179 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
7180 sockets. <level> can be one of :
7181 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
7182 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
7183 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
7184 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
7185 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
7186 counters).
7187 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
7188 all counters).
7189
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007190maxconn <maxconn>
7191 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
7192 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
7193 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
7194 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
7195 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
7196 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
7197 eat all memory.
7198
7199mode <mode>
7200 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
7201 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
7202 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
7203 UNIX sockets.
7204
7205mss <maxseg>
7206 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
7207 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
7208 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
7209 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
7210 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
7211 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
7212 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
7213 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
7214 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
7215 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
7216 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
7217
7218name <name>
7219 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
7220 page.
7221
7222nice <nice>
7223 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
7224 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
7225 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
7226 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
7227 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
7228 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
7229 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
7230 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
7231 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
7232 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
7233 one for an RDP socket.
7234
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007235no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007236 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7237 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instanciated from the listener when
7238 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007239 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7240 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007241
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02007242no-tls-tickets
7243 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7244 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7245 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7246 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
7247
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007248no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007249 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007250 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7251 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7252 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7253 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007254
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007255no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007256 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007257 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7258 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7259 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7260 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007261
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007262no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007263 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007264 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7265 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7266 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7267 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007268
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02007269npn <protocols>
7270 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
7271 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
7272 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
7273 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
7274 enabled (check with haproxy -vv).
7275
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007276ssl
7277 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7278 enables SSL deciphering on connections instanciated from this listener. A
7279 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
7280 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
7281 to deciphered contents.
7282
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01007283strict-sni
7284 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
7285 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
7286 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
7287 See the "crt" option for more information.
7288
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007289tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01007290 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007291 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
7292 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
7293 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
7294 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
7295 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
7296 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
7297 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
7298 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
7299
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007300transparent
7301 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7302 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
7303 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
7304 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
7305 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
7306 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
7307 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
7308 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
7309 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
7310 so check for support with your vendor.
7311
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01007312v4v6
7313 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
7314 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
7315 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
7316 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
7317 sockets, and is overriden by the "v6only" option.
7318
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01007319v6only
7320 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
7321 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
7322 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01007323 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
7324 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01007325
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007326uid <uid>
7327 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
7328 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7329 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
7330 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
7331 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7332
7333user <user>
7334 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
7335 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7336 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
7337 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
7338 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7339
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007340verify [none|optional|required]
7341 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7342 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
7343 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
7344 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
7345 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007346 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
7347 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7348 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
7349 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007350
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020073515.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007352------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007353
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007354The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
7355which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
7356arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
7357settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
7358after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
7359Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
7360address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007361
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007362 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007363 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007364
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007365The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007366
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007367addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007368 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
7369 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
7370 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
7371 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
7372 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007373
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007374 Supported in default-server: No
7375
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007376backup
7377 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
7378 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
7379 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
7380 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
7381 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
7382 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007383
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007384 Supported in default-server: No
7385
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007386ca-file <cafile>
7387 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7388 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7389 server's certificate.
7390
7391 Supported in default-server: No
7392
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007393check
7394 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01007395 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
7396 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
7397 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
7398 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
7399 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
7400 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
7401 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormana2b9dad2013-02-12 10:45:54 +09007402 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the
7403 "httpchk", "lb-agent-chk", "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and
7404 "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please refer to those options and parameters for
7405 more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007406
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007407 Supported in default-server: No
7408
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02007409check-send-proxy
7410 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
7411 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
7412 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
7413 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
7414 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
7415 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
7416 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
7417
7418 Supported in default-server: No
7419
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007420check-ssl
7421 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
7422 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
7423 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
7424 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
7425 inserts an SSL transport layer below the ckecks, so that a simple TCP connect
7426 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
7427 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
7428 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
7429 See the "ssl" option for more information.
7430
7431 Supported in default-server: No
7432
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007433ciphers <ciphers>
7434 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
7435 is negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
7436 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
7437 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
7438 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
7439 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
7440 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
7441 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
7442
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007443 Supported in default-server: No
7444
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007445cookie <value>
7446 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
7447 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
7448 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
7449 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
7450 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
7451 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
7452 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
7453
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007454 Supported in default-server: No
7455
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007456crl-file <crlfile>
7457 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7458 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7459 to verify server's certificate.
7460
7461 Supported in default-server: No
7462
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02007463crt <cert>
7464 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7465 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
7466 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
7467 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
7468 certificate request.
7469
7470 Supported in default-server: No
7471
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02007472disabled
7473 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
7474 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
7475 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
7476 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
7477 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
7478
7479 Supported in default-server: No
7480
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007481error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007482 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
7483 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
7484 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007485
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007486 Supported in default-server: Yes
7487
7488 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007489
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007490fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007491 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
7492 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
7493 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
7494
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007495 Supported in default-server: Yes
7496
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007497force-sslv3
7498 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7499 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
7500 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7501
7502 Supported in default-server: No
7503
7504force-tlsv10
7505 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7506 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7507
7508 Supported in default-server: No
7509
7510force-tlsv11
7511 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7512 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7513
7514 Supported in default-server: No
7515
7516force-tlsv12
7517 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7518 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7519
7520 Supported in default-server: No
7521
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007522id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007523 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
7524 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
7525 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007526
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007527 Supported in default-server: No
7528
7529inter <delay>
7530fastinter <delay>
7531downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007532 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
7533 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
7534 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
7535 between checks depending on the server state :
7536
7537 Server state | Interval used
7538 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7539 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
7540 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7541 Transitionally UP (going down), |
7542 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7543 or yet unchecked. |
7544 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7545 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7546 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007547
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007548 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
7549 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
7550 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
7551 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
7552 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
7553 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
7554 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
7555 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
7556 servers.
7557
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007558 Supported in default-server: Yes
7559
7560maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007561 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
7562 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
7563 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
7564 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
7565 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
7566 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
7567 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
7568 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
7569
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007570 Supported in default-server: Yes
7571
7572maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007573 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
7574 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
7575 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
7576 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
7577 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
7578 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
7579 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
7580
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007581 Supported in default-server: Yes
7582
7583minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007584 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
7585 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
7586 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
7587 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
7588 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
7589 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007590 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007591 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007592
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007593 Supported in default-server: Yes
7594
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007595no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007596 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
7597 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007598 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007599
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007600 Supported in default-server: No
7601
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02007602no-tls-tickets
7603 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7604 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7605 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7606 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
7607
7608 Supported in default-server: No
7609
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007610no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007611 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007612 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7613 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007614 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7615 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007616
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007617 Supported in default-server: No
7618
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007619no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007620 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007621 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7622 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007623 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7624 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007625
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007626 Supported in default-server: No
7627
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007628no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007629 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007630 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7631 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007632 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7633 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007634
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007635 Supported in default-server: No
7636
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09007637non-stick
7638 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
7639 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
7640 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
7641
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007642 Supported in default-server: No
7643
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007644observe <mode>
7645 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
7646 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
7647 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
7648 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
7649 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
7650 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01007651 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007652
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007653 Supported in default-server: No
7654
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007655 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
7656
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007657on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007658 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
7659 Currently, four modes are available:
7660 - fastinter: force fastinter
7661 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
7662 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
7663 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
7664 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
7665
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007666 Supported in default-server: Yes
7667
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007668 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
7669
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007670on-marked-down <action>
7671 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
7672 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007673 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
7674 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
7675 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
7676 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
7677 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
7678 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
7679 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
7680 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007681
7682 Actions are disabled by default
7683
7684 Supported in default-server: Yes
7685
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007686on-marked-up <action>
7687 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
7688 Currently one action is available:
7689 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
7690 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
7691 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
7692 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
7693 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
7694 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
7695 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
7696 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
7697
7698 Actions are disabled by default
7699
7700 Supported in default-server: Yes
7701
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007702port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007703 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
7704 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
7705 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
7706 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
7707 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
7708 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
7709
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007710 Supported in default-server: Yes
7711
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007712redir <prefix>
7713 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
7714 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
7715 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
7716 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
7717 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
7718 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
7719 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
7720 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007721 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007722 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
7723 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
7724 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
7725 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
7726 loop between the client and HAProxy!
7727
7728 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
7729
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007730 Supported in default-server: No
7731
7732rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007733 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
7734 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
7735 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
7736
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007737 Supported in default-server: Yes
7738
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007739send-proxy
7740 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
7741 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
7742 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
7743 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
7744 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
7745 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
7746 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
7747 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
7748 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02007749 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
7750 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
7751 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
7752 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
7753 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007754
7755 Supported in default-server: No
7756
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007757slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007758 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
7759 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
7760 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
7761 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
7762 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
7763 parameters :
7764
7765 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
7766 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
7767
7768 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
7769 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
7770 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
7771 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
7772
7773 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
7774 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
7775 seen as failed.
7776
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007777 Supported in default-server: Yes
7778
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007779source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007780source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007781source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007782 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
7783 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
7784 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
7785 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
7786
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007787 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
7788 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
7789 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
7790 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
7791 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
7792 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
7793 server.
7794
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007795 Supported in default-server: No
7796
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007797ssl
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007798 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. At
7799 the moment, server certificates are not checked, so this is prone to man in
7800 the middle attacks. The real intended use is to permit SSL communication
7801 with software which cannot work in other modes over networks that would
7802 otherwise be considered safe enough for clear text communications. When this
7803 option is used, health checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there
7804 is a "port" or an "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a
7805 different location. See the "check-ssl" optino to force SSL health checks.
7806
7807 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007808
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007809track [<proxy>/]<server>
7810 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
7811 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
7812 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
7813 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
7814 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
7815
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007816 Supported in default-server: No
7817
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007818verify [none|required]
7819 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7820 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. This is the default. In the
7821 other case, The certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from
7822 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7823 is aborted.
7824
7825 Supported in default-server: No
7826
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007827weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007828 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
7829 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
7830 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02007831 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
7832 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
7833 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
7834 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
7835 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
7836 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007837
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007838 Supported in default-server: Yes
7839
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007840
78416. HTTP header manipulation
7842---------------------------
7843
7844In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
7845response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
7846request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
7847which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
7848against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
7849to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
7850passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
7851headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
7852never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
7853
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007854There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
7855(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
7856rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
7857messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
7858in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007859happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007860add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
7861normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
7862
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007863This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
7864in section 4.2 :
7865
7866 - reqadd <string>
7867 - reqallow <search>
7868 - reqiallow <search>
7869 - reqdel <search>
7870 - reqidel <search>
7871 - reqdeny <search>
7872 - reqideny <search>
7873 - reqpass <search>
7874 - reqipass <search>
7875 - reqrep <search> <replace>
7876 - reqirep <search> <replace>
7877 - reqtarpit <search>
7878 - reqitarpit <search>
7879 - rspadd <string>
7880 - rspdel <search>
7881 - rspidel <search>
7882 - rspdeny <search>
7883 - rspideny <search>
7884 - rsprep <search> <replace>
7885 - rspirep <search> <replace>
7886
7887With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
7888is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
7889parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
7890prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
7891Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
7892
7893 \t for a tab
7894 \r for a carriage return (CR)
7895 \n for a new line (LF)
7896 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
7897 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
7898 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
7899 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
7900 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
7901
7902The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
7903portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
7904above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
7905regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
79069 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
7907is very common to users of the "sed" program.
7908
7909The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
7910after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
7911
7912Notes related to these keywords :
7913---------------------------------
7914 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
7915 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
7916 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
7917
7918 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
7919 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
7920 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
7921
7922 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
7923 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
7924 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
7925 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
7926 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
7927
7928 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
7929 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
7930 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
7931 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
7932 useless headers before adding new ones.
7933
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007934 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007935 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
7936
7937 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
7938 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
7939 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
7940
7941 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
7942 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007943 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007944
7945
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010079467. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
7947------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007948
7949The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
7950content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
7951from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
7952simple :
7953
7954 - define test criteria with sets of values
7955 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
7956
7957The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
7958
7959In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
7960
7961 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
7962
7963This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
7964Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
7965and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
7966an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
7967of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
7968
7969ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
7970'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
7971which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
7972
7973There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
7974performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
7975
7976The following ACL flags are currently supported :
7977
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007978 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
7979 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007980 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
7981
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007982The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
7983specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
7984possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007985multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
7986be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
7987needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
7988space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
7989match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
7990lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
7991duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007992to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceding it. For
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007993instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007994
7995 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
7996
7997In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
7998the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
7999case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
8000too.
8001
8002Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
8003a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
8004ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
8005
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008006Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008007
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008008 - integers or integer ranges
8009 - strings
8010 - regular expressions
8011 - IP addresses and networks
8012
8013
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080147.1. Matching integers
8015----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008016
8017Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
8018that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
8019expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
8020may be omitted.
8021
8022For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
8023unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
8024representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
8025
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008026As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
8027two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
8028instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
8029ranges and operators.
8030
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008031For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008032operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
8033Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
8034of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008035
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008036Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008037
8038 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
8039 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
8040 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
8041 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
8042 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
8043
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008044For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008045
8046 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
8047
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008048This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
8049
8050 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
8051
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008052
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080537.2. Matching strings
8054---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008055
8056String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
8057exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
8058characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
8059string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
8060to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008061before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008062
8063
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080647.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
8065-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008066
8067Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
8068they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
8069possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
8070passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
8071the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008072the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
8073match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008074
8075
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020080767.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008077----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008078
8079IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
8080netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
8081within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008082host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008083difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
8084at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
8085does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
8086parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008087
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008088IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
8089Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
8090trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
8091IPv6 patterns.
8092
8093HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
8094following situations :
8095 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
8096 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
8097 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
8098 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
8099 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
8100 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
8101 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
8102 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
8103 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
8104 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
8105
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008106
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020081077.5. Available matching criteria
8108--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008109
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020081107.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
8111------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008112
8113A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
8114analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008115addresses and ports, as well as internal values independent on the stream.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008116
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008117always_false
8118 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
8119 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
8120
8121always_true
8122 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
8123 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
8124
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008125avg_queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008126avg_queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008127 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
8128 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
8129 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
8130 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
8131 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
8132 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
8133 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
8134 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
8135 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
8136 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
8137 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01008138
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008139be_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008140be_conn(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008141 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
8142 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
8143 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
8144 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
8145 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008146
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01008147be_id <integer>
8148 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
8149 backend it was called.
8150
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008151be_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008152be_sess_rate(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008153 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
8154 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
8155 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
8156 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
8157 sucking of an online dictionary).
8158
8159 Example :
8160 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
8161 backend dynamic
8162 mode http
8163 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
8164 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008165
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -05008166srv_sess_rate(<backend>/<server>) <integer>
8167 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the server matches the
8168 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
8169 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
8170 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
8171 latent requests from overloading servers).
8172
8173 Example :
8174 # Redirect to a separate back
8175 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
8176 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
8177 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
8178
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008179connslots <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008180connslots(<backend>) <integer>
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008181 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008182 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008183 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
8184
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008185 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
8186 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008187
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008188 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008189 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
8190 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
8191 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
8192 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
8193 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008194 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008195
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008196 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
8197 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
8198 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
8199 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008200
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008201dst <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008202 Applies to the local IPv4 or IPv6 address the client connected to. It can be
8203 used to switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008204
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008205dst_conn <integer>
8206 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
8207 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
8208 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
8209 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
8210 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
8211 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
8212
8213dst_port <integer>
8214 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
8215 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
8216
8217fe_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008218fe_conn(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008219 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
8220 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
8221 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
8222 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
8223 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
8224 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
8225 criteria.
8226
8227fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008228 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008229 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008230
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008231fe_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008232fe_sess_rate(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008233 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
8234 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
8235 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
8236 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
8237 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
8238 the rate to go down below the limit.
8239
8240 Example :
8241 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
8242 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
8243 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
8244 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
8245 frontend mail
8246 bind :25
8247 mode tcp
8248 maxconn 100
8249 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
8250 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
8251 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
8252 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008253
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008254nbsrv <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008255nbsrv(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008256 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
8257 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
8258 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
8259 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
8260 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008261
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008262queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008263queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008264 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
8265 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
8266 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
8267 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
8268 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
8269 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
8270 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
8271
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008272sc1_bytes_in_rate <integer>
8273sc2_bytes_in_rate <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008274 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
8275 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
8276 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
8277
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008278sc1_bytes_out_rate <integer>
8279sc2_bytes_out_rate <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008280 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
8281 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
8282 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
8283
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008284sc1_clr_gpc0 <integer>
8285sc2_clr_gpc0 <integer>
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008286 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
8287 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008288 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
8289 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
8290 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008291
8292 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
8293 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
8294 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8295 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008296 acl save sc1_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008297 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
8298 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8299
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008300sc1_conn_cnt <integer>
8301sc2_conn_cnt <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008302 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
8303 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
8304
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008305sc1_conn_cur <integer>
8306sc2_conn_cur <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008307 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
8308 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
8309 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
8310
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008311sc1_conn_rate <integer>
8312sc2_conn_rate <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008313 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
8314 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
8315 See also src_conn_rate.
8316
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008317sc1_get_gpc0 <integer>
8318sc2_get_gpc0 <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008319 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
8320 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
8321
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008322sc1_http_err_cnt <integer>
8323sc2_http_err_cnt <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008324 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
8325 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
8326 See also src_http_err_cnt.
8327
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008328sc1_http_err_rate <integer>
8329sc2_http_err_rate <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008330 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
8331 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
8332 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
8333 src_http_err_rate.
8334
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008335sc1_http_req_cnt <integer>
8336sc2_http_req_cnt <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008337 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
8338 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
8339 src_http_req_cnt.
8340
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008341sc1_http_req_rate <integer>
8342sc2_http_req_rate <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008343 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
8344 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
8345 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
8346 src_http_req_rate.
8347
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008348sc1_inc_gpc0 <integer>
8349sc2_inc_gpc0 <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008350 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008351 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
8352 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
8353 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
8354 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008355
8356 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008357 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008358 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8359
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008360sc1_kbytes_in <integer>
8361sc2_kbytes_in <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008362 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
8363 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
8364 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
8365 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
8366
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008367sc1_kbytes_out <integer>
8368sc2_kbytes_out <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008369 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
8370 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
8371 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
8372 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
8373
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008374sc1_sess_cnt <integer>
8375sc2_sess_cnt <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008376 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
8377 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
8378 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
8379 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008380 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008381 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
8382
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008383sc1_sess_rate <integer>
8384sc2_sess_rate <integer>
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008385 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
8386 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
8387 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
8388 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
8389 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008390 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008391
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008392sc1_trackers <integer>
8393sc2_trackers <integer>
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01008394 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
8395 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
8396 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc1_conn_cur in
8397 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
8398 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
8399 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking.
8400
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008401so_id <integer>
8402 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
8403
8404src <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008405 Applies to the client's IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is usually used to limit
8406 access to certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level
8407 source address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008408
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008409src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008410src_bytes_in_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008411 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
8412 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8413 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008414 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008415
8416src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008417src_bytes_out_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008418 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
8419 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8420 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008421 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008422
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008423src_clr_gpc0 <integer>
8424src_clr_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
8425 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
8426 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8427 stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not found, an
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008428 entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a second ACL in
8429 an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008430
8431 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
8432 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
8433 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
8434 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008435 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008436 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
8437 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8438
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008439src_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008440src_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008441 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
8442 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
8443 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008444 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008445
8446src_conn_cur <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008447src_conn_cur(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008448 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
8449 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
8450 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008451 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008452
8453src_conn_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008454src_conn_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008455 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
8456 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8457 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008458 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008459
8460src_get_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008461src_get_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008462 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
8463 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
8464 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008465 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008466
8467src_http_err_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008468src_http_err_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008469 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
8470 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8471 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008472 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008473
8474src_http_err_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008475src_http_err_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008476 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
8477 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
8478 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
8479 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008480 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008481
8482src_http_req_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008483src_http_req_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008484 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
8485 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8486 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008487 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008488
8489src_http_req_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008490src_http_req_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008491 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
8492 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8493 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
8494 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008495 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008496
8497src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008498src_inc_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008499 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
8500 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008501 stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not found, an entry
8502 is created and 1 is returned. This is typically used as a second ACL in an
8503 expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008504
8505 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008506 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008507 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008508
8509src_kbytes_in <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008510src_kbytes_in(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008511 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
8512 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8513 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
8514 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008515 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008516
8517src_kbytes_out <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008518src_kbytes_out(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008519 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
8520 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8521 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
8522 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008523 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008524
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008525src_port <integer>
8526 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008527
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008528src_sess_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008529src_sess_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008530 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
8531 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
8532 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
8533 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008534 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008535
8536src_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008537src_sess_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008538 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
8539 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8540 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
8541 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008542 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008543
8544src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008545src_updt_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008546 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008547 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
8548 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008549 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
8550 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
8551 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008552 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008553
8554 Example :
8555 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
8556 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
8557 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
8558 listen ssh
8559 bind :22
8560 mode tcp
8561 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008562 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008563 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
8564 server local 127.0.0.1:22
8565
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008566srv_conn(<backend>/<server>) <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02008567 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the server,
8568 possibly including the connection being evaluated.
8569 It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is full.
8570 See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" criteria.
8571
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01008572srv_id <integer>
8573 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
8574
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02008575srv_is_up(<server>)
8576srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
8577 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
8578 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
8579 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
8580 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
8581 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
8582 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
8583 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
8584 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
8585
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008586table_avl <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008587table_avl(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008588 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
8589 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
8590
8591table_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008592table_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008593 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
8594 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
8595 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
8596
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008597
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020085987.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
8599---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008600
8601A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
8602during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008603through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
8604keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008605
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008606rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8607 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8608 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8609 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008610 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8611 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8612 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008613
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008614req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008615 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008616 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
8617 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
8618 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
8619 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
8620 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
8621 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
8622
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008623req_proto_http
8624 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
8625 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008626 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008627 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
8628 using TCP request content inspection rules.
8629
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008630req_rdp_cookie <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008631req_rdp_cookie(<name>) <string>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008632 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
8633 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
8634 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
8635 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
8636 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
8637 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
8638 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
8639 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
8640
8641req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008642req_rdp_cookie_cnt(<name>) <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008643 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
8644 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
8645 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
8646 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
8647 cookies.
8648
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008649req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8650 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8651 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8652 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008653 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8654 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8655 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008656
8657req_ssl_sni <string>
8658 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8659 or superior) client hello message with a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8660 (SNI) matching <string>. SNI normally contains the name of the host the
8661 client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing
8662 or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This
8663 test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection. If content
8664 switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait for a complete client
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008665 hello (type 1), like in the example below. Note that this only applies to raw
8666 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008667 SSL transport layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008668 option. See also "ssl_sni" below.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008669
8670 Examples :
8671 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
8672 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8673 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
8674 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
8675 default_backend bk_sorry_page
8676
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008677req_ssl_ver <decimal>
8678 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
8679 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
8680 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
8681 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
8682 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
8683 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008684 with TCP request content inspection. Note that this only applies to raw
8685 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008686 SSL transport layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008687 option.
8688
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008689ssl_c_ca_err <integer>
8690 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8691 layer, and the ID of the first error detected during verification of the
8692 client certificate at depth > 0 matches the specified value (check man verify
8693 for possible values). Note that error zero means no error was encountered
8694 during this verification process.
8695
8696ssl_c_ca_err_depth <integer>
8697 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8698 layer, and the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
8699 verification of the client certificate matches the specified value. When no
8700 error is found, depth 0 is returned.
8701
8702ssl_c_err <integer>
8703 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8704 layer, and the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth==0
8705 matches the specified value (check man verify for possible values). Note that
8706 error zero means no error was encountered during this verification process.
8707
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008708ssl_c_i_dn <string>
8709ssl_c_i_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8710 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8711 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8712 issuer of the certificate presented by the client matches the specified
8713 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8714 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8715 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8716 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8717 DN matches the specified string.
8718
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008719ssl_c_key_alg <string>
8720 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8721 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the
8722 certificate presented by the client matches the string.
8723
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02008724ssl_c_notafter <string>
8725 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8726 layer, and the end date of the certificate presented by the client matches
8727 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8728
8729ssl_c_notbefore <string>
8730 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8731 layer, and the start date of the certificate presented by the client matches
8732 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8733
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008734ssl_c_s_dn <string>
8735ssl_c_s_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8736 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8737 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8738 subject of the certificate presented by the client matches the specified
8739 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8740 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8741 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8742 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8743 DN matches the specified string.
8744
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02008745ssl_c_serial <hexa>
8746 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8747 layer, and the serial of the certificate presented by the client matches
8748 the value written in hexa.
8749
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008750ssl_c_sig_alg <string>
8751 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8752 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented
8753 by the client matches the string.
8754
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01008755ssl_c_used
8756 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
8757 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
8758
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008759ssl_c_verify <integer>
8760 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8761 layer, and the verify result matches the specified value (check man verify
8762 for possible values). Zero indicates no error was detected.
8763
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02008764ssl_c_version <integer>
8765 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8766 layer, and the version of the certificate presented by the client matches
8767 the value.
8768
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008769ssl_f_i_dn <string>
8770ssl_f_i_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8771 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8772 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8773 issuer of the certificate presented by the frontend matches the specified
8774 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8775 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8776 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8777 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8778 DN matches the specified string.
8779
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008780ssl_c_key_alg <string>
8781 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8782 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the
8783 certificate presented by the frontend matches the string.
8784
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02008785ssl_f_notafter <string>
8786 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8787 layer, and the end date of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8788 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8789
8790ssl_f_notbefore <string>
8791 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8792 layer, and the start date of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8793 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8794
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008795ssl_f_s_dn <string>
8796ssl_f_s_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8797 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8798 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8799 subject of the certificate presented by the frontend matches the specified
8800 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8801 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8802 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8803 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8804 DN matches the specified string.
8805
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02008806ssl_f_serial <hexa>
8807 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8808 layer, and the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8809 the value written in hexa.
8810
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008811ssl_f_sig_alg <string>
8812 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8813 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented
8814 by the frontend matches the string.
8815
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02008816ssl_f_version <integer>
8817 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8818 layer, and the version of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8819 the value.
8820
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008821ssl_fc
8822 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
8823 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
8824 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
8825
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008826ssl_fc_alg_keysize <integer>
8827 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8828 layer and the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits matches the value.
8829
8830ssl_fc_cipher <string>
8831 returns true when the incoming connection was made over an ssl/tls transport
8832 layer and the name of the used cipher matches the string.
8833
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008834ssl_fc_has_crt
8835 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
8836 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01008837 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
8838 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
8839 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
8840 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008841
8842ssl_fc_has_sni
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008843 This is used to check for presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008844 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
8845 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
8846 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
8847 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008848
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008849ssl_fc_npn <string>
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02008850 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8851 layer which deciphered it and found a Next Protocol Negociation TLS extension
8852 sent by the client, matching the specified string. This requires that the SSL
8853 library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008854 Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on
8855 the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to
8856 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be requested.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02008857
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008858ssl_fc_protocol <string>
8859 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8860 layer and the name of the used protocol matches the string.
8861
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008862ssl_fc_sni <string>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008863 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8864 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8865 sent by the client, matching the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8866 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008867 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8868 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008869 See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_req" below. This requires that the
8870 SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
8871 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008872
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008873ssl_fc_sni_end <string>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008874 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8875 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8876 sent by the client, ending like the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8877 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008878 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8879 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This
8880 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
8881 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008882
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008883ssl_fc_sni_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008884 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8885 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8886 sent by the client, matching the specified regex. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8887 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008888 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8889 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This
8890 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
8891 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008892
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008893ssl_fc_use_keysize <integer>
8894 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8895 layer and the symmetric cipher key size used in bits matches the value.
8896
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02008897wait_end
8898 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
8899 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
8900 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
8901 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
8902 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
8903 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
8904 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
8905 inspection.
8906
8907 Examples :
8908 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
8909 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
8910 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
8911
8912 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
8913 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
8914 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
8915 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
8916 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
8917 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
8918 tcp-request content reject
8919
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008920
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020089217.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
8922--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008923
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008924A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008925application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
8926read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
8927than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
8928
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008929base <string>
8930 Returns true when the concatenation of the first Host header and the path
8931 part of the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the
8932 question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be used to match known
8933 files in virtual hosting environments, such as "www.example.com/favicon.ico".
8934 See also "path" and "uri".
8935
8936base_beg <string>
8937 Returns true when the base (see above) begins with one of the strings. This
8938 can be used to send certain directory names to alternative backends. See also
8939 "path_beg".
8940
8941base_dir <string>
8942 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8943 slashes in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "url_dir" and
8944 "path_dir" instead.
8945
8946base_dom <string>
8947 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8948 in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "path_dom" and "url_dom"
8949 instead.
8950
8951base_end <string>
8952 Returns true when the base (see above) ends with one of the strings. This may
8953 be used to control file name extension, though "path_end" is cheaper.
8954
8955base_len <integer>
8956 Returns true when the base (see above) length matches the values or ranges
8957 specified. This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8958
8959base_reg <regex>
8960 Returns true when the base (see above) matches one of the regular
8961 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
8962 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg", "url_reg"
8963 and all "base_" criteria.
8964
8965base_sub <string>
8966 Returns true when the base (see above) contains one of the strings. It can be
8967 used to detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See
8968 also "base_dir".
8969
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008970cook(<name>) <string>
8971 All "cook*" matching criteria inspect all "Cookie" headers to find a cookie
8972 with the name between parenthesis. If multiple occurrences of the cookie are
8973 found in the request, they will all be evaluated. Spaces around the name and
8974 the value are ignored as requested by the Cookie specification (RFC6265). The
8975 cookie name is case-sensitive. Use the scook() variant for response cookies
8976 sent by the server.
8977
8978 The "cook" criteria returns true if any of the request cookies <name> match
8979 any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For instance,
8980 checking that the "profile" cookie is set to either "silver" or "gold" :
8981
8982 cook(profile) silver gold
8983
8984cook_beg(<name>) <string>
8985 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> begins with one of the
8986 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8987 scook_beg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8988
8989cook_cnt(<name>) <integer>
8990 Returns true when the number of occurrences of the specified cookie matches
8991 the values or ranges specified. This is used to detect presence, absence or
8992 abuse of a specific cookie. See "cook" for more information on header
8993 matching. Use the scook_cnt() variant for response cookies sent by the
8994 server.
8995
8996cook_dir(<name>) <string>
8997 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8998 either isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8999 directory name matching, though it generally is of limited use with cookies.
9000 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_dir()
9001 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
9002
9003cook_dom(<name>) <string>
9004 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
9005 either isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name
9006 matching. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
9007 scook_dom() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
9008
9009cook_end(<name>) <string>
9010 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> ends with one of the
9011 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
9012 scook_end() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
9013
9014cook_len(<name>) <integer>
9015 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> has a length which matches
9016 the values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
9017 cookie values. Note that an absent cookie does not match a zero-length test.
9018 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_len()
9019 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
9020
9021cook_reg(<name>) <regex>
9022 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> matches any of the regular
9023 expressions. It can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that
9024 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also other "cook_" criteria,
9025 as well as "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
9026 scook_reg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
9027
9028cook_sub(<name>) <string>
9029 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains at least one of
9030 the strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
9031 scook_sub() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
9032
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +02009033cook_val(<name>) <integer>
9034 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> starts with a number which
9035 matches the values or ranges specified. This may be used to select a server
9036 based on application-specific cookies. Note that an absent cookie does not
9037 match any value. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
9038 scook_val() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
9039
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009040hdr <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009041hdr(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009042 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
9043 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
9044 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
9045 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009046 If an occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, only
9047 this occurrence will be considered. Positive values indicate a position from
9048 the first occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9049 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. Use the shdr()
9050 variant for response headers sent by the server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009051
9052 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009053 match any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values. For
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009054 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
9055
9056 hdr(Connection) -i close
9057
9058hdr_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009059hdr_beg(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009060 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
9061 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
9062 response headers sent by the server.
9063
9064hdr_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009065hdr_cnt(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009066 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
9067 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
9068 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
9069 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
9070 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
9071 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
9072 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
9073
9074hdr_dir <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009075hdr_dir(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009076 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
9077 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
9078 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
9079 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
9080 headers sent by the server.
9081
9082hdr_dom <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009083hdr_dom(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009084 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
9085 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
9086 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
9087 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
9088 server.
9089
9090hdr_end <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009091hdr_end(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009092 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
9093 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
9094 response headers sent by the server.
9095
9096hdr_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009097hdr_ip(<header>[,<occ>]) <address>
9098 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
9099 matching <address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For
9100 or X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009101 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
9102
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02009103hdr_len <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009104hdr_len(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02009105 Returns true when at least one of the headers has a length which matches the
9106 values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
9107 headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
9108 shdr_len() variant for response headers sent by the server.
9109
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009110hdr_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009111hdr_reg(<header>[,<occ>]) <regex>
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009112 Returns true it one of the headers matches one of the regular expressions. It
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009113 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
9114 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
9115 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
9116 response headers sent by the server.
9117
9118hdr_sub <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009119hdr_sub(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009120 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
9121 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
9122 response headers sent by the server.
9123
9124hdr_val <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009125hdr_val(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009126 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
9127 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
9128 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
9129 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
9130
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009131http_auth(<userlist>)
9132http_auth_group(<userlist>) <group> [<group>]*
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009133 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
9134 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
9135 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
9136 of specified groups.
9137
9138 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
9139
Willy Tarreau85c27da2011-09-16 07:53:52 +02009140http_first_req
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02009141 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
9142 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
9143 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
9144 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
9145
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009146method <string>
9147 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
9148 already check for most common methods.
9149
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009150path <string>
9151 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
9152 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
9153 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
9154
9155path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009156 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
9157 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009158
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009159path_dir <string>
9160 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
9161 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
9162 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
9163 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
9164
9165path_dom <string>
9166 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
9167 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
9168 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
9169
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009170path_end <string>
9171 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
9172 control file name extension.
9173
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02009174path_len <integer>
9175 Returns true when the path length matches the values or ranges specified.
9176 This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
9177
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009178path_reg <regex>
9179 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
9180 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
9181 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
9182
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009183path_sub <string>
9184 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
9185 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
9186 "path_dir".
9187
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +02009188payload(<offset>,<length>) <string>
9189 Returns true if the block of <length> bytes, starting at byte <offset> in the
9190 request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of the
9191 strings.
9192
9193payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
9194 Returns true if the block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
9195 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
9196 the request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of
9197 the strings. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
9198 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
9199
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009200req_ver <string>
9201 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
9202 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
9203
9204status <integer>
9205 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
9206 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
9207 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
9208
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009209url <string>
9210 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009211 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL. See also "base".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009212
9213url_beg <string>
9214 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009215 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme. See also
9216 "base_beg".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009217
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009218url_dir <string>
9219 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
9220 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
9221 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
9222 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
9223
9224url_dom <string>
9225 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
9226 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
9227 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
9228
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009229url_end <string>
9230 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
9231 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009232
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009233url_ip <address>
9234 Applies to the IPv4 or IPv6 address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP
9235 request. It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local
9236 network. It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01009237
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02009238url_len <integer>
9239 Returns true when the url length matches the values or ranges specified. This
9240 may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
9241
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01009242url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009243 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
9244 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009245 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009246 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01009247
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009248url_reg <regex>
9249 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
9250 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009251 than other methods. See also "base_reg", "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009252
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009253url_sub <string>
9254 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
9255 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009256
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009257urlp(<name>) <string>
9258 Note: all "urlp*" matching criteria apply to the first occurrence of the
9259 parameter <name> in the query string. The parameter name is case-sensitive.
9260
9261 The "urlp" matching criteria returns true if the designated URL parameter
9262 matches any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values.
9263
9264urlp_beg(<name>) <string>
9265 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" begins with one of the strings.
9266 This can be used to check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a
9267 protocol scheme.
9268
9269urlp_dir(<name>) <string>
9270 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings
9271 either isolated or delimited with slashes. This is used to perform filename
9272 or directory name matching in a specific URL parameter without the risk of
9273 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "path_dir" and "urlp_sub".
9274
9275urlp_dom(<name>) <string>
9276 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
9277 in the URL parameter "<name>". This is used to perform domain name matching
9278 in a specific URL parameter without the risk of wrong match due to colliding
9279 prefixes. See also "urlp_sub".
9280
9281urlp_end(<name>) <string>
9282 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" ends with one of the strings.
9283
9284urlp_ip(<name>) <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009285 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
9286 which matches one of the specified addresses.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009287
9288urlp_len(<name>) <integer>
9289 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" has a length matching the values
9290 or ranges specified. This is used to detect abusive requests for instance.
9291
9292urlp_reg(<name>) <regex>
9293 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" matches one of the regular
9294 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
9295 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all
9296 "urlp_" criteria.
9297
9298urlp_sub(<name>) <string>
9299 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings. It
9300 can be used to detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See
9301 also "path_sub" and other "urlp_" criteria.
9302
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +02009303urlp_val(<name>) <integer>
9304 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" starts with a number matching
9305 the values or ranges specified. Note that the absence of the parameter does
9306 not match anything. Integers are unsigned so it is not possible to match
9307 negative data.
9308
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009309
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093107.6. Pre-defined ACLs
9311---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009312
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009313Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
9314every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009315order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009316
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009317ACL name Equivalent to Usage
9318---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009319FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02009320HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009321HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
9322HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009323HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
9324HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
9325HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
9326HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
9327LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009328METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
9329METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
9330METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
9331METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
9332METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
9333METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009334RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009335REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009336TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009337WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
9338---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009339
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009340
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093417.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
9342----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009344Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9345combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009346
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009347 - AND (implicit)
9348 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9349 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009350
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009351A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009352
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009353 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009354
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009355Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9356indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009357
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009358For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9359"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9360requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9361is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009362
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009363 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9364 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9365 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9366 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009367
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009368To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9369and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009370
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009371 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9372 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9373 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9374 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009375
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009376 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9377 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9378 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9379 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009380
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01009381It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9382expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9383be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009384the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01009385
9386 The following rule :
9387
9388 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9389 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9390
9391 Can also be written that way :
9392
9393 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9394
9395It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9396to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9397simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9398sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9399good use is the following :
9400
9401 With named ACLs :
9402
9403 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9404 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9405 monitor fail if site_dead
9406
9407 With anonymous ACLs :
9408
9409 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9410
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009411See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009412
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01009413
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010094147.8. Pattern extraction
9415-----------------------
9416
9417The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
9418response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
9419for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
9420
9421All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
9422"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
9423begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
9424arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
9425much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
9426equivalent used in ACLs.
9427
9428The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
9429
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009430 base This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the
9431 path part of the request, which starts at the first slash and
9432 ends before the question mark. It can be useful in virtual
9433 hosted environments to detect URL abuses as well as to improve
9434 shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size stick
9435 table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
9436 requested objects by host/path.
9437
Willy Tarreauab1f7b72012-12-09 13:38:54 +01009438 base32 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base"
9439 fetch method above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on
9440 high traffic sites without having to store all URLs. Instead a
9441 shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
9442 is an unsigned integer.
9443
Willy Tarreau4a550602012-12-09 14:53:32 +01009444 base32+src This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the
9445 src fetch below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a
9446 size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on the source address family.
9447 This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
9448
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009449 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009450 It is of type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9451 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
9452 according to RFC 4291.
9453
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009454 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
9455 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
9456 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009457 type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9458 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
9459 according to RFC 4291.
9460
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009461 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
9462 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
9463 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
9464 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
9465 type integer and only works with such tables.
9466
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009467 hdr(<name>[,<occ>])
9468 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
9469 request. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as
9470 a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
9471 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
9472 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the
9473 last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once
Willy Tarreaue428fb72011-12-16 21:50:30 +01009474 converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02009475
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02009476 path This extracts the request's URL path (without the host part). A
9477 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
9478 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
9479 keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing caches, it would be
9480 wiser to use "url" instead.
9481
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009482 payload(<offset>,<length>)
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009483 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
9484 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
9485 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
9486 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009487
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009488 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009489 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
9490 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
9491 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
9492 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
9493 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
9494 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
9495 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
9496 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009497
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009498 src_port This is the source TCP port of the session on the client side,
9499 which is the port the client connected from. It is very unlikely
9500 that this function will be useful but it's available at no cost.
9501 It is of type integer and only works with such tables.
9502
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009503 ssl_c_ca_err Returns the ID of the first error detected during verify of the
9504 client certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was detected.
9505
9506 ssl_c_ca_err_depth
9507 Returns the depth of the first error detected during verify. If
9508 no error is encountered in the CA chain, zero is returned.
9509
9510 ssl_c_err Returns the ID of the first error detected during verify of the
9511 client certificate at depth == 0, or 0 if no errors.
9512
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009513 ssl_c_i_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9514 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9515 the issuer of the certificate presented by the client when
9516 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009517 layer. Otherwise returns the value of the first given entry
9518 found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009519 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9520 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9521 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9522 name ssl_c_i_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9523 ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2).
9524
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009525 ssl_c_key_alg
9526 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of
9527 the certificate presented by the client when the incoming
9528 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9529
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009530 ssl_c_notafter
9531 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted
9532 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9533 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9534
9535 ssl_c_notbefore
9536 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted
9537 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9538 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9539
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009540 ssl_c_s_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9541 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9542 the subject of the certificate presented by the client when
9543 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009544 layer. Otherwise returns the value of the first given entry
9545 found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009546 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9547 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9548 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9549 name ssl_c_s_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9550 ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2).
9551
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009552 ssl_c_serial Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client
9553 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9554 layer.
9555
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009556 ssl_c_sig_alg
9557 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate
9558 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made
9559 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9560
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01009561 ssl_c_used
9562 Returns 1 if current SSL session use a client certificate,
9563 otherwise 0. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
9564
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009565 ssl_c_verify Returns the verify result errorID when the incoming connection
9566 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no
9567 error is encountered.
9568
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009569 ssl_c_version
9570 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client
9571 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9572 layer.
9573
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009574 ssl_f_i_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9575 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9576 the issuer of the certificate presented by the frontend when
9577 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009578 layer. Otherwise returns the value of the first given entry
9579 found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009580 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9581 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9582 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9583 name ssl_f_i_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9584 ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2).
9585
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009586 ssl_f_key_alg
9587 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of
9588 the certificate presented by the frontend when the incoming
9589 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9590
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009591 ssl_f_notafter
9592 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted
9593 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9594 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9595
9596 ssl_f_notbefore
9597 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted
9598 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9599 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9600
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009601 ssl_f_s_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9602 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9603 the subject of the certificate presented by the frontend when
9604 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009605 layer. Otherwise returns the value of the first given entry
9606 found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009607 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9608 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9609 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9610 name ssl_f_s_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9611 ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2).
9612
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009613 ssl_f_serial Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend
9614 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9615 layer.
9616
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009617 ssl_f_sig_alg
9618 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate
9619 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made
9620 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9621
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009622 ssl_f_version
9623 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend
9624 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9625 layer.
9626
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009627 ssl_fc This checks the transport layer used on the front connection,
9628 and returns 1 if it was made via an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9629 otherwise zero.
9630
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009631 ssl_fc_alg_keysize
9632 Returns the symmetric cipher key size support d in bits when the
9633 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9634
9635 ssl_fc_cipher
9636 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection
9637 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9638
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009639 ssl_fc_has_crt
9640 Returns 1 if a client certificate is present in the front
9641 connection over SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise 0.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01009642 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket,
9643 client certificate is not present in the current connection but
9644 may be retrieved from the cache or the ticket. So prefer
9645 "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if current SSL session uses
9646 a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009647
9648 ssl_fc_has_sni
9649 This checks the transport layer used by the front connection, and
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009650 returns 1 if the connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
9651 layer and the client sent a Server Name Indication TLS extension,
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009652 otherwise zero. This requires that the SSL library is build with
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009653 support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009654
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009655 ssl_fc_npn This extracts the Next Protocol Negociation field from an
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02009656 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and
9657 locally deciphered by haproxy. The result is a string containing
9658 the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL library must
9659 have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009660 haproxy -vv). See also the "npn" bind keyword.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02009661
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009662 ssl_fc_protocol
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01009663 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming
9664 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009665
Emeric Brunfe68f682012-10-16 14:59:28 +02009666 ssl_fc_session_id
9667 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming
9668 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful to
9669 stick on a given client.
9670
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009671 ssl_fc_sni This extracts the Server Name Indication field from an incoming
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009672 connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
9673 deciphered by haproxy. The result typically is a string matching
9674 the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must
9675 have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
9676 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009677
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009678 ssl_fc_use_keysize
9679 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the
9680 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9681
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02009682 url This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A
9683 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
9684 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
9685 keep them in caches. See also "path".
9686
9687 url_ip This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the
9688 host part is presented as an IP address. Its use is very
9689 limited. For instance, a monitoring system might use this field
9690 as an alternative for the source IP in order to test what path a
9691 given source address would follow, or to force an entry in a
9692 table for a given source address.
9693
9694 url_port This extracts the port part from the request's URL. It probably
9695 is totally useless but it was available at no cost.
9696
bedis4c75cca2012-10-05 08:38:24 +02009697 url_param(<name>[,<delim>])
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009698 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in
bedis4c75cca2012-10-05 08:38:24 +02009699 the parameter string of the request and uses the corresponding
9700 value to match. Optionally, a delimiter can be provided. If not
9701 then the question mark '?' is used by default.
9702 A typical use is to get sticky session through url for cases
9703 where cookies cannot be used.
9704
9705 Example :
9706 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
9707 stick on url_param(PHPSESSIONID)
9708 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
9709 stick on url_param(JSESSIONID,;)
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09009710
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009711 rdp_cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009712 This extracts the value of the rdp cookie <name> as a string
9713 and uses this value to match. This enables implementation of
9714 persistence based on the mstshash cookie. This is typically
9715 done if there is no msts cookie present.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009716
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009717 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing
9718 algorithm may be used and thus the distribution of clients
9719 to backend servers is not linked to a hash of the RDP
9720 cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
9721 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconnect" will
9722 lead to a more even distribution of clients to backend
9723 servers than the hash used by "balance rdp-cookie".
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009724
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009725 Example :
9726 listen tse-farm
9727 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
9728 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9729 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9730 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9731 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9732 persist rdp-cookie
9733 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
9734 # This is only useful makes sense if
9735 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
9736 stick-table type string size 204800
9737 stick on rdp_cookie(mstshash)
9738 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9739 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009740
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009741 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie",
9742 "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009743
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009744 cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009745 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02009746 "Cookie" header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header
9747 from the response, and uses the corresponding value to match. A
9748 typical use is to get multiple clients sharing a same profile
9749 use the same server. This can be similar to what "appsession"
9750 does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
9751 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009752
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009753 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009754
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009755 set-cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02009756 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the
9757 "cookie" fetch which is capable of handling both requests and
9758 responses. This keyword will disappear soon.
9759
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009760 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
9761 "Set-Cookie" header line from the response and uses the
9762 corresponding value to match. This can be comparable to what
9763 "appsession" does with default options, but with support for
9764 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009765
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009766 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009767
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009768
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009769The currently available list of transformations include :
9770
9771 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
9772 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
9773 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
9774
9775 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
9776 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
9777 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
9778
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009779 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01009780 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
9781 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
9782 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
9783 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
9784
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009785
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020097868. Logging
9787----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009788
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009789One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
9790provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
9791very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
9792provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
9793state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009794to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009795headers.
9796
9797In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
9798about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
9799send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
9800
9801 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
9802 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
9803 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
9804 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
9805 at the termination.
9806
9807The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
9808allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
9809as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
9810while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
9811real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
9812delay.
9813
9814
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020098158.1. Log levels
9816---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009817
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009818TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009819source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009820HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
9821in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
9822track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
9823syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
9824about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009825
9826
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020098278.2. Log formats
9828----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009829
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009830HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009831and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
9832slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
9833options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009834
9835 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
9836 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
9837 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
9838 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
9839 extents.
9840
9841 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
9842 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
9843 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
9844 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
9845 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
9846
9847 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
9848 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
9849 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
9850 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
9851 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
9852
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009853 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
9854 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
9855 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
9856 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
9857
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009858 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
9859
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009860Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
9861specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
9862field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
9863servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
9864always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
9865identifier.
9866
9867Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
9868 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
9869 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
9870 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
9871 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
9872
9873
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020098748.2.1. Default log format
9875-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009876
9877This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
9878as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
9879format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
9880
9881 Example :
9882 listen www
9883 mode http
9884 log global
9885 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9886
9887 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
9888 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
9889 (www/HTTP)
9890
9891 Field Format Extract from the example above
9892 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
9893 2 'Connect from' Connect from
9894 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
9895 4 'to' to
9896 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
9897 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
9898
9899Detailed fields description :
9900 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
9901 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
9902 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
9903 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
9904 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9905 and processed the connection.
9906 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
9907
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009908In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
9909"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
9910connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
9911
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009912It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
9913will eventually disappear.
9914
9915
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020099168.2.2. TCP log format
9917---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009918
9919The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
9920is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
9921information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
9922counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
9923emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
9924environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
9925the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
9926sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009927specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
9928not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
9929fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
9930marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009931
9932 Example :
9933 frontend fnt
9934 mode tcp
9935 option tcplog
9936 log global
9937 default_backend bck
9938
9939 backend bck
9940 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9941
9942 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
9943 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
9944 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
9945
9946 Field Format Extract from the example above
9947 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
9948 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
9949 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
9950 4 frontend_name fnt
9951 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
9952 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
9953 7 bytes_read* 212
9954 8 termination_state --
9955 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
9956 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
9957
9958Detailed fields description :
9959 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009960 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
9961 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
9962 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
9963 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
9964 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009965
9966 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009967 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
9968 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
9969 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009970
9971 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
9972 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
9973 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
9974 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
9975
9976 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9977 and processed the connection.
9978
9979 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
9980 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
9981 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
9982 applications.
9983
9984 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
9985 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
9986 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
9987 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
9988 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
9989
9990 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
9991 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
9992 See "Timers" below for more details.
9993
9994 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
9995 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
9996 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
9997 "Timers" below for more details.
9998
9999 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
10000 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
10001 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
10002 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
10003 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
10004 details.
10005
10006 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
10007 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
10008 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
10009 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
10010 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
10011
10012 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
10013 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
10014 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
10015 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
10016 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
10017 for more details.
10018
10019 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010020 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010021 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
10022 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
10023 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010024 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010025
10026 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
10027 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
10028 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
10029 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
10030 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
10031 caused by a denial of service attack.
10032
10033 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
10034 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
10035 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
10036 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
10037 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
10038 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
10039 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
10040 denial of service attack.
10041
10042 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
10043 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
10044 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
10045 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
10046 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
10047 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
10048 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
10049 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
10050 be processed than on other servers.
10051
10052 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
10053 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
10054 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
10055 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
10056 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
10057 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
10058 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
10059 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
10060 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
10061 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
10062 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
10063 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
10064 should not be attributed to the logged server.
10065
10066 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10067 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
10068 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
10069 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
10070 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
10071 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
10072 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
10073 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
10074
10075 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10076 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
10077 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
10078 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
10079 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
10080 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
10081 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
10082 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
10083 occurs.
10084
10085
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200100868.2.3. HTTP log format
10087----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010088
10089The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
10090is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
10091the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
10092are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
10093emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
10094generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
10095"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
10096which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010097frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
10098is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010099
10100Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
10101slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
10102with a star ('*') after the field name below.
10103
10104 Example :
10105 frontend http-in
10106 mode http
10107 option httplog
10108 log global
10109 default_backend bck
10110
10111 backend static
10112 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
10113
10114 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
10115 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
10116 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010117 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010118
10119 Field Format Extract from the example above
10120 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
10121 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
10122 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
10123 4 frontend_name http-in
10124 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
10125 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
10126 7 status_code 200
10127 8 bytes_read* 2750
10128 9 captured_request_cookie -
10129 10 captured_response_cookie -
10130 11 termination_state ----
10131 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
10132 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
10133 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
10134 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
10135 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010136
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010137
10138Detailed fields description :
10139 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010140 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
10141 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
10142 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
10143 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
10144 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010145
10146 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010147 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
10148 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
10149 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010150
10151 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
10152 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
10153 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
10154 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
10155 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
10156
10157 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
10158 and processed the connection.
10159
10160 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
10161 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
10162 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
10163
10164 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
10165 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
10166 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
10167 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
10168 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
10169 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
10170
10171 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
10172 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
10173 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
10174 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
10175 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
10176 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
10177
10178 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
10179 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
10180 See "Timers" below for more details.
10181
10182 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
10183 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
10184 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
10185 below for more details.
10186
10187 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
10188 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
10189 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
10190 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
10191 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
10192 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
10193 for more details.
10194
10195 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
10196 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
10197 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
10198 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
10199 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
10200 details.
10201
10202 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
10203 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
10204 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
10205
10206 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
10207 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
10208 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
10209 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
10210 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
10211 overflowing.
10212
10213 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
10214 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
10215 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
10216 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
10217 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
10218 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
10219 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
10220 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
10221
10222 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
10223 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
10224 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
10225 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
10226 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
10227 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
10228 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
10229 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
10230
10231 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
10232 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
10233 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
10234 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
10235 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
10236 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
10237 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
10238
10239 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010240 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010241 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
10242 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
10243 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010244 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010245 system.
10246
10247 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
10248 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
10249 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
10250 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
10251 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
10252 caused by a denial of service attack.
10253
10254 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
10255 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
10256 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
10257 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
10258 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
10259 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
10260 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
10261 denial of service attack.
10262
10263 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
10264 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
10265 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
10266 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
10267 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
10268 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
10269 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
10270 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
10271 processed than on other servers.
10272
10273 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
10274 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
10275 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
10276 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
10277 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
10278 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
10279 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
10280 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
10281 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
10282 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
10283 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
10284 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
10285 should not be attributed to the logged server.
10286
10287 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10288 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
10289 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
10290 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
10291 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
10292 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
10293 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
10294 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
10295
10296 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10297 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
10298 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
10299 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
10300 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
10301 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
10302 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
10303 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
10304 occurs.
10305
10306 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
10307 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
10308 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
10309 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
10310 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
10311 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
10312 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
10313 cookies" below for more details.
10314
10315 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
10316 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
10317 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
10318 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
10319 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
10320 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
10321 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
10322 and cookies" below for more details.
10323
10324 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
10325 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
10326 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
10327 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
10328 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
10329 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
10330 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
10331 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
10332
10333
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200103348.2.4. Custom log format
10335------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010336
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010337The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010338mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010339
10340HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
10341Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
10342separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
10343prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
10344
10345Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
10346variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
10347string formats ("Q").
10348
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010010349If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
10350as a pattern extraction rule (see section 7.8). This it useful to add some
10351less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
10352the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
10353
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010354Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
10355HAproxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
10356
10357Flags are :
10358 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010359 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010360
10361 Example:
10362
10363 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
10364 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
10365
10366At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
10367
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010368 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
10369 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010370
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010371the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010372
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010373 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010374 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010375 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010376
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010377and the default TCP format is defined this way :
10378
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010379 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010380 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
10381
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010382Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
10383
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010384 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010385 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010386 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
10387 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
10388 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010389 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
10390 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
10391 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010392 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010393 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010394 | H | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010395 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010396 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080010397 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010398 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
10399 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010400 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010401 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
10402 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010403 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010404 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
10405 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010406 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
10407 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
10408 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010409 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010410 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
10411 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010412 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010413 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
10414 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
10415 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010416 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010417 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
10418 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
10419 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
10420 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010421 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010422 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010423 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010424 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010425 | H | %rt | http_request_counter | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010426 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010427 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
10428 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
10429 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010430 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010431 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
10432 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010433 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010434 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010435 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010436 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010437
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010438 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010439
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010010440
104418.2.5. Error log format
10442-----------------------
10443
10444When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
10445protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
10446By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
10447"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
10448will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
10449logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
10450
10451The format looks like this :
10452
10453 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
10454 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
10455 Connection error during SSL handshake
10456
10457 Field Format Extract from the example above
10458 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
10459 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
10460 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
10461 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
10462 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
10463
10464These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
10465failures.
10466
10467
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200104688.3. Advanced logging options
10469-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010470
10471Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
10472just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
10473options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
10474for more information about their usage.
10475
10476
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200104778.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
10478------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010479
10480It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
10481haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
10482commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
10483monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
10484ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
10485
10486 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
10487 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
10488 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
10489 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
10490
10491 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
10492 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
10493 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
10494 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
10495 such as other load-balancers.
10496
10497 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
10498 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
10499 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
10500
10501
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200105028.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
10503----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010504
10505The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
10506what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
10507or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
10508"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
10509just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
10510log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
10511after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
10512is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
10513with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
10514with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
10515
10516
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200105178.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
10518------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010519
10520Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
10521for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
10522"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
10523retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
10524raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
10525a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
10526file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
10527you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
10528"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
10529
10530
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200105318.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
10532--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010533
10534Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
10535multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
10536them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
10537"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
10538logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
10539error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
10540and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
10541too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
10542useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
10543alternative.
10544
10545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200105468.4. Timing events
10547------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010548
10549Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
10550reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
10551the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
10552frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
10553mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
10554
10555 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
10556 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
10557 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
10558 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
10559 the client closes prematurely or times out.
10560
10561 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
10562 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
10563 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
10564 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
10565 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
10566
10567 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
10568 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
10569 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
10570 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
10571 connection never established.
10572
10573 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
10574 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
10575 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
10576 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
10577 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
10578 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
10579 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
10580 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
10581 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
10582 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
10583 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
10584
10585 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
10586 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
10587 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
10588 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
10589 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
10590
10591 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
10592
10593 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
10594 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
10595 negative.
10596
10597These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
10598protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
10599that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010600due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010601close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
10602session has been aborted on timeout.
10603
10604Most common cases :
10605
10606 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
10607 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
10608 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
10609 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
10610 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
10611 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
10612 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
10613 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
10614 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020010615 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
10616 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
10617 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010618
10619 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
10620 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
10621 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
10622 of ms on remote networks.
10623
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010624 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
10625 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
10626 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010627
10628 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
10629 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
10630 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
10631 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
10632 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
10633 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
10634 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
10635 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
10636 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
10637 to the server until another one is released.
10638
10639Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
10640
10641 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
10642 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
10643 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
10644
10645 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
10646 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
10647 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
10648
10649 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
10650 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
10651 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
10652 flags.
10653
10654 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
10655 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
10656 Check the session termination flags, then check the
10657 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
10658 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
10659 the client connection was maintained open.
10660
10661 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
10662 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
10663 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
10664 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
10665
10666
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200106678.5. Session state at disconnection
10668-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010669
10670TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
10671"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
106722-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
10673each of which has a special meaning :
10674
10675 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
10676 session to terminate :
10677
10678 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
10679
10680 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
10681 server explicitly refused it.
10682
10683 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
10684 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
10685 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
10686 error in server response which might have caused information leak
10687 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
10688 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
10689
10690 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
10691 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
10692 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
10693 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
10694 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
10695
10696 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
10697 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
10698 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
10699 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
10700 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
10701
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090010702 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
10703 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
10704
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010705 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
10706 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
10707 backup connections when going up.
10708
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020010709 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
10710
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010711 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
10712 send or receive data.
10713
10714 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
10715 send or receive data.
10716
10717 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
10718 with nothing left in the buffers.
10719
10720 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
10721
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010010722 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010723 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
10724
10725 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
10726 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
10727 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
10728 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
10729 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
10730
10731 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
10732 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
10733
10734 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
10735 server (HTTP only).
10736
10737 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
10738
10739 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
10740 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
10741 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
10742
10743 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
10744 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
10745 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
10746
10747 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
10748
10749 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
10750 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
10751
10752 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
10753 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
10754 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
10755
10756 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
10757 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020010758 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
10759 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010760
10761 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
10762 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
10763 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
10764 another server.
10765
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010766 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010767 server.
10768
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010769 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
10770 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
10771 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
10772 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
10773
10774 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
10775 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
10776 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
10777 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
10778
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020010779 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
10780 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
10781 "use-server" rule).
10782
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010783 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
10784
10785 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
10786 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
10787
10788 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
10789
10790 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
10791 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
10792 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
10793
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010794 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
10795 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
10796 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
10797 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
10798 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
10799
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010800 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
10801
10802 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
10803 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
10804
10805 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
10806
10807 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
10808
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010809The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
10810was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010811helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
10812starvation, attacks, etc...
10813
10814The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
10815alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
10816easier finding and understanding.
10817
10818 Flags Reason
10819
10820 -- Normal termination.
10821
10822 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
10823 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
10824 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
10825 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
10826
10827 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
10828 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
10829 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
10830 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
10831 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
10832 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010833
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010834 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
10835 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010836 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010837
10838 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
10839 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
10840 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
10841
10842 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
10843 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
10844 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
10845 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
10846 the server takes too long to respond.
10847
10848 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
10849 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
10850 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
10851 long a time to respond.
10852
10853 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
10854 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
10855 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
10856 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
10857 and the client.
10858
10859 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
10860 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
10861 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
10862 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
10863 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
10864 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
10865
10866 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
10867 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010868 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
10869 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
10870 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
10871 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010872
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010873 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010874 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
10875 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
10876 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
10877 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
10878 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
10879
10880 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
10881 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
10882 503 or 504 here.
10883
10884 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
10885 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
10886 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
10887 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
10888 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
10889
10890 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
10891 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010892 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010893 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
10894 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
10895
10896 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
10897 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
10898 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
10899 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
10900 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
10901 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
10902 between haproxy and the server.
10903
10904 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
10905 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
10906 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
10907 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
10908 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
10909 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
10910 solution is to fix the application.
10911
10912 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
10913 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
10914 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
10915 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
10916 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
10917 external attacks.
10918
10919 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
10920 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010921 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010922 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
10923 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
10924
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010010925 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
10926 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
10927 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
10928 the client.
10929
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010930 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
10931 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
10932 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
10933 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010010934 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
10935 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
10936 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
10937 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
10938 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010939
10940 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
10941 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
10942 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
10943 returned an HTTP 403 error.
10944
10945 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
10946 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
10947 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
10948 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
10949
10950 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
10951 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
10952 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
10953 only be solved by proper system tuning.
10954
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010955The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
10956persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
10957important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
10958re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
10959
10960 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
10961
10962 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
10963 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
10964 set on a GET request.
10965
10966 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
10967 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010968 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010969 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
10970
10971 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
10972 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
10973 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
10974
10975 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
10976 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
10977 already got a cookie.
10978
10979 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
10980 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
10981 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
10982 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
10983 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
10984
10985 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
10986 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
10987 new cookie was inserted in the response.
10988
10989 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
10990 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
10991 new cookie was inserted in the response.
10992
10993 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
10994 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
10995
10996 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
10997 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
10998 then advertised in the response.
10999
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011000
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110018.6. Non-printable characters
11002-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011003
11004In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
11005consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
11006converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
11007prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
11008being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
11009escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
11010is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
11011'}' when logging headers.
11012
11013Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
11014issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
11015containing spaces is "User-Agent".
11016
11017Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
11018the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
11019performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
11020
11021
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110228.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
11023---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011024
11025Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
11026achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011027section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011028cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
11029the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
11030the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011031locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011032not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
11033user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
11034a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
11035wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
11036
11037 Examples :
11038 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
11039 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
11040
11041 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
11042 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
11043
11044
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110458.8. Capturing HTTP headers
11046---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011047
11048Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
11049proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
11050the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
11051server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
11052
11053Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
11054response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011055section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011056
11057It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011058time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
11059appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011060are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
11061and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
11062follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
11063request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
11064in the logs.
11065
11066 Example :
11067 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
11068 listen proxy-out
11069 mode http
11070 option httplog
11071 option logasap
11072 log global
11073 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
11074
11075 # log the name of the virtual server
11076 capture request header Host len 20
11077
11078 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
11079 capture request header Content-Length len 10
11080
11081 # log the beginning of the referrer
11082 capture request header Referer len 20
11083
11084 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
11085 capture response header Server len 20
11086
11087 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
11088 capture response header Content-Length len 10
11089
11090 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
11091 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
11092
11093 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
11094 capture response header Via len 20
11095
11096 # log the URL location during a redirection
11097 capture response header Location len 20
11098
11099 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
11100 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
11101 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
11102 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
11103 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
11104
11105 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
11106 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
11107 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
11108 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011109 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011110
11111 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
11112 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
11113 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
11114 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
11115 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011116 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011117
11118
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111198.9. Examples of logs
11120---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011121
11122These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
11123them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
11124reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
11125
11126 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
11127 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
11128 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
11129
11130 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
11131 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
11132
11133 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
11134 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
11135 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
11136
11137 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
11138 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
11139
11140 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
11141 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
11142 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
11143
11144 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011145 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011146 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
11147 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
11148
11149 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
11150 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
11151 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
11152
11153 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
11154 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020011155 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011156 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
11157 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
11158 to return the 502 and not the server.
11159
11160 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011161 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011162
11163 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
11164 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
11165 Nothing was sent to any server.
11166
11167 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
11168 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
11169
11170 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
11171 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
11172 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
11173 send a 408 return code to the client.
11174
11175 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
11176 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
11177
11178 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
11179 5 seconds ("c----").
11180
11181 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
11182 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011183 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011184
11185 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011186 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011187 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
11188 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
11189 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
11190 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
11191 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011192
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011193
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111949. Statistics and monitoring
11195----------------------------
11196
11197It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
11198mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
11199CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
11200Unix socket.
11201
11202
112039.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011204---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011205
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010011206The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
11207page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
11208
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011209 0. pxname: proxy name
11210 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
11211 for server)
11212 2. qcur: current queued requests
11213 3. qmax: max queued requests
11214 4. scur: current sessions
11215 5. smax: max sessions
11216 6. slim: sessions limit
11217 7. stot: total sessions
11218 8. bin: bytes in
11219 9. bout: bytes out
11220 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011221 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011222 12. ereq: request errors
11223 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010011224 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011225 15. wretr: retries (warning)
11226 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010011227 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011228 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
11229 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
11230 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
11231 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
11232 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
11233 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
11234 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
11235 25. qlimit: queue limit
11236 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
11237 27. iid: unique proxy id
11238 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
11239 29. throttle: warm up status
11240 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
11241 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020011242 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020011243 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
11244 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
11245 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020011246 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011247 UNK -> unknown
11248 INI -> initializing
11249 SOCKERR -> socket error
11250 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
11251 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
11252 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
11253 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
11254 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
11255 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11256 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11257 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
11258 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
11259 disable-on-404
11260 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11261 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11262 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020011263 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
11264 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011265 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
11266 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
11267 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
11268 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
11269 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
11270 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011271 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
11272 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
11273 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
11274 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010011275 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
11276 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau55058a72012-11-21 08:27:21 +010011277 51. comp_in: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
11278 52. comp_out: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
11279 53. comp_byp: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor (CPU/BW limit)
Willy Tarreau11d4ec82012-11-26 00:49:03 +010011280 54. comp_rsp: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011281
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011282
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112839.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011284-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011285
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011286The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011287must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
11288is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
11289a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
11290risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
11291followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
11292given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
11293then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
11294to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011295
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011296It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
11297on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
11298own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011299
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011300clear counters
11301 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
11302 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
11303 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
11304 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
11305 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
11306
11307clear counters all
11308 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
11309 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
11310 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
11311
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011312clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
11313 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
11314
11315 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
11316 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
11317 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
11318 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
11319 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
11320 later after the session ends is usual enough.
11321
11322 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
11323
11324 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
11325 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
11326 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
11327 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
11328 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
11329 the ACLs :
11330
11331 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
11332 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
11333 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
11334 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
11335 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
11336 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
11337
11338 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090011339 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
11340 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011341
11342 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011343 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011344 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011345 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
11346 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
11347 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11348 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011349
11350 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11351
11352 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011353 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011354 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11355 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011356 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11357 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11358 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011359
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011360disable frontend <frontend>
11361 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
11362 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
11363 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
11364 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
11365 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
11366 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
11367 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
11368 on the stats page.
11369
11370 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11371 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11372
11373 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11374 level "admin".
11375
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011376disable server <backend>/<server>
11377 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
11378 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
11379 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
11380 during the maintenance.
11381
11382 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
11383 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
11384
11385 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011386 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011387
11388 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11389 level "admin".
11390
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011391enable frontend <frontend>
11392 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
11393 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
11394 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
11395 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
11396 which was disabled.
11397
11398 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11399 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11400
11401 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11402 level "admin".
11403
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011404enable server <backend>/<server>
11405 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
11406 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
11407
11408 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011409 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011410
11411 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11412 level "admin".
11413
11414get weight <backend>/<server>
11415 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
11416 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
11417 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
11418 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
11419 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011420 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011421
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011422help
11423 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
11424 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011425
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011426prompt
11427 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
11428 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
11429 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
11430 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
11431 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
11432 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
11433 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
11434 command.
11435
11436quit
11437 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011438
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020011439set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020011440 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
11441 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
11442 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
11443 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
11444 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020011445 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
11446 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11447
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020011448set maxconn global <maxconn>
11449 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
11450 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
11451 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
11452 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
11453 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
11454 setting.
11455
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020011456set rate-limit connections global <value>
11457 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
11458 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
11459 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
11460 is passed in number of connections per second.
11461
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010011462set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
11463 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
11464 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010011465 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
11466 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010011467
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020011468set table <table> key <key> data.<data_type> <value>
11469 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
11470 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
11471 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
11472 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
11473 IP address or affect its quality of service.
11474
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011475set timeout cli <delay>
11476 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
11477 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
11478 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
11479
11480set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
11481 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
11482 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090011483 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
11484 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
11485 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
11486 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
11487 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
11488 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
11489 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
11490 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
11491 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
11492 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
11493 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
11494 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
11495 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011496
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011497show errors [<iid>]
11498 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
11499 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020011500 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
11501 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
11502 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011503
11504 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
11505 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
11506 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
11507 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
11508 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
11509 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
11510 are reported too.
11511
11512 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
11513 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
11514 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
11515 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
11516 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
11517 code.
11518
11519 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
11520 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
11521 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
11522 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
11523 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
11524 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
11525 line.
11526
11527 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011528 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11529 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011530 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
11531 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
11532
11533 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
11534 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
11535 00038 Location: blah\r\n
11536 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
11537 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
11538 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
11539 00204+ minal\r\n
11540 00211 \r\n
11541
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011542 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011543 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
11544 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
11545 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
11546 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
11547 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
11548 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011549
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011550show info
11551 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
11552
11553show sess
11554 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020011555 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
11556 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
11557
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010011558show sess <id>
11559 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
11560 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
11561 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
11562 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
11563 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Willy Tarreau76153662012-11-26 01:16:39 +010011564 freely evolve depending on demands. The special id "all" dumps the states of
11565 all sessions, which can be avoided as much as possible as it is highly CPU
11566 intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011567
11568show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
11569 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
11570 possible to dump only selected items :
11571 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
11572 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
11573 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
11574 for example:
11575 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
11576 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
11577 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
11578
11579 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011580 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
11581 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011582 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
11583 Release_date: 2009/09/23
11584 Nbproc: 1
11585 Process_num: 1
11586 (...)
11587
11588 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
11589 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
11590 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
11591 (...)
11592 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
11593
11594 $
11595
11596 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
11597 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
11598 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
11599 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011600 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011601
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011602show table
11603 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
11604 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
11605 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
11606 entries currently in use.
11607
11608 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011609 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011610 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
11611 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011612
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011613show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011614 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
11615 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
11616 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011617 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
11618
11619 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
11620 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
11621 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
11622 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
11623 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
11624
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011625 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
11626 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
11627 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
11628 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
11629 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
11630 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
11631
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011632
11633 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090011634 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
11635 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011636
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011637 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011638 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011639 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011640 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
11641 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
11642 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11643 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011644
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011645 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011646 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011647 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11648 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011649
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011650 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
11651 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011652 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011653 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11654 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011655
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011656 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
11657 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011658 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011659 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11660 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
11661
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011662 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
11663 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
11664 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
11665 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
11666 time goes, the average event rate drops.
11667
11668 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
11669 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
11670 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011671 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
11672 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011673 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
11674 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020011675
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011676shutdown frontend <frontend>
11677 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
11678 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
11679 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
11680 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
11681 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
11682 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
11683 once it is terminated.
11684
11685 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11686 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11687
11688 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11689 level "admin".
11690
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020011691shutdown session <id>
11692 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
11693 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
11694 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
11695 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
11696 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
11697 flag in the logs.
11698
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020011699shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
11700 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
11701 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
11702 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
11703 'K' flag in the logs.
11704
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011705/*
11706 * Local variables:
11707 * fill-column: 79
11708 * End:
11709 */